* Makefile.in (CXX_FOR_TARGET_FOR_RECURSIVE_MAKE, RECURSE_FLAGS):
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
b6ba6518
KB
2@c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3@c 1999, 2000, 2001
c906108c
SS
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
5d161b24 6@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
c906108c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
41afff9a 25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 27@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 28@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
e9c75b65 31@set EDITION Ninth
c906108c
SS
32
33@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
e9c75b65 34@set DATE April 2001
c906108c 35
6d2ebf8b 36@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 3.12 OR LATER.
c906108c 37
c906108c 38@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 39@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
40@dircategory Programming & development tools.
41@direntry
c906108c 42* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
43@end direntry
44
c906108c
SS
45@ifinfo
46This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
47
48
5d161b24 49This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
c906108c
SS
50of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
51for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
52
e9c75b65
EZ
53Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1990,1991,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1998,1999,2000,2001
54 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 55
e9c75b65
EZ
56Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
57under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
58any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
59Invariant Sections being ``A Sample GDB Session'' and ``Free
60Software'', with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and
61with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
c906108c 62
e9c75b65
EZ
63(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
64this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
65Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
c906108c
SS
66@end ifinfo
67
68@titlepage
69@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
70@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 71@sp 1
c906108c
SS
72@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
73@subtitle @value{DATE}
9e9c5ae7 74@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 75@page
c906108c
SS
76@tex
77{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 78\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
79\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
80\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
81}
82@end tex
53a5351d 83
c906108c 84@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
e9c75b65
EZ
85Copyright @copyright{} 1988,1989,1990,1991,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1998,1999,2000,2001
86 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 87@sp 2
c906108c
SS
88Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
8959 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
90Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b 91ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
e9c75b65
EZ
92
93Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
94under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
95any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
96Invariant Sections being ``A Sample GDB Session'' and ``Free
97Software'', with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and
98with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
99
100(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
101this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
102Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
c906108c
SS
103@end titlepage
104@page
105
b9deaee7 106@ifinfo
6d2ebf8b
SS
107@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
108
c906108c
SS
109@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
110
111This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
112
5d161b24 113This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
114@value{GDBVN}.
115
e9c75b65 116Copyright (C) 1988-2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6d2ebf8b
SS
117
118@menu
119* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
120* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
121
122* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
123* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
124* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
125* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
126* Stack:: Examining the stack
127* Source:: Examining source files
128* Data:: Examining data
b37052ae 129* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
6d2ebf8b
SS
130
131* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
132
133* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
134* Altering:: Altering execution
135* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
136* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
137* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
138* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
139* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
140* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
141* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 142* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
143
144* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
145* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
146
147* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
148* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
149* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
150* Index:: Index
151@end menu
152
b9deaee7 153@end ifinfo
6d2ebf8b
SS
154
155@c the replication sucks, but this avoids a texinfo 3.12 lameness
156
157@ifhtml
158@node Top
159
160@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
161
162This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
163
b37052ae 164This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
6d2ebf8b
SS
165@value{GDBVN}.
166
167Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
168
c906108c
SS
169@menu
170* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
c906108c 171* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
c906108c
SS
172
173* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
174* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
175* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
176* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
177* Stack:: Examining the stack
178* Source:: Examining source files
179* Data:: Examining data
c906108c 180
7a292a7a 181* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
c906108c
SS
182
183* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
184* Altering:: Altering execution
185* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
186* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
104c1213 187* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
c906108c
SS
188* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
189* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c906108c 190* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6d2ebf8b 191* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
c906108c
SS
192
193* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 194* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
c906108c
SS
195
196* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
197* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
198* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
199* Index:: Index
c906108c
SS
200@end menu
201
6d2ebf8b
SS
202@end ifhtml
203
449f3b6c
AC
204@c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
205@iftex
206@contents
207@end iftex
208
6d2ebf8b 209@node Summary
c906108c
SS
210@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
211
212The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
213going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
214program was doing at the moment it crashed.
215
216@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
217these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
218
219@itemize @bullet
220@item
221Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
222
223@item
224Make your program stop on specified conditions.
225
226@item
227Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
228
229@item
230Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
231effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
232@end itemize
233
cce74817 234You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 235For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
236For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
237
cce74817
JM
238@cindex Chill
239@cindex Modula-2
c906108c 240Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
cce74817 241see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
c906108c 242
cce74817
JM
243@cindex Pascal
244Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
245nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
246entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
247syntax.
c906108c 248
c906108c
SS
249@cindex Fortran
250@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 251it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 252underscore.
c906108c 253
c906108c
SS
254@menu
255* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
256* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257@end menu
258
6d2ebf8b 259@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
260@unnumberedsec Free software
261
5d161b24 262@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
263General Public License
264(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273from anyone else.
274
6d2ebf8b 275@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
276@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
277
278Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
279other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
280development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
281of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
282to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
283file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
284blow-by-blow account.
285
286Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
287
288@quotation
289@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
290or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
291omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
292@end quotation
293
294So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
295particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
296releases:
b37052ae 297Andrew Cagney (releases 5.0 and 5.1);
c906108c
SS
298Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
299Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
300Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
301Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
302Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
303John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
304Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
305and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
306
307Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
308Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
309
b37052ae
EZ
310Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
311in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
312Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
313demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
314much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c 315
b37052ae 316@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
c906108c
SS
317object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
318Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
319
320David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
321the original support for encapsulated COFF.
322
96c405b3 323Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
c906108c
SS
324
325Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
326Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
327support.
328Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
329Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
330Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
331David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
332Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
333Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
334Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
335Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
336Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
337Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
338Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
339Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
340Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
341Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
342Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
343
344Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
345
346Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
347libraries.
348
349Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
350about several machine instruction sets.
351
352Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
353remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
354contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
355and RDI targets, respectively.
356
357Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
358command-line editing and command history.
359
7a292a7a
SS
360Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
361Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 362
5d161b24 363Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
b37052ae 364He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
c906108c 365symbols.
c906108c
SS
366
367Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
368Super-H processors.
369
370NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
371
372Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
373
374Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
375
376Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
377
96a2c332 378Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
379
380Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
381watchpoints.
382
383Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
384
385Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
386
387Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 388nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
389
390The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
391support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
b37052ae 392(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
c906108c
SS
393compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
394John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
395Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
396information in this manual.
397
b37052ae
EZ
398DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
399Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
400
96a2c332
SS
401Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
402development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
403fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
404Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
405Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
406Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
407Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
408addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
409JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
410Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
411Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
412Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
413Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
414Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
415Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c
SS
416
417
6d2ebf8b 418@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
419@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
420
421You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
422However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
423debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
424
425@iftex
426In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
427to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
428@end iftex
429
430@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
431@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
432
433One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
434processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
435quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
436definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
437session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
438then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
439same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
440@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
441procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
442
443@smallexample
444$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
445$ @b{./m4}
446@b{define(foo,0000)}
447
448@b{foo}
4490000
450@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
451
452@b{bar}
4530000
454@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
455
456@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
457@b{baz}
458@b{C-d}
459m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
460@end smallexample
461
462@noindent
463Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
464
c906108c
SS
465@smallexample
466$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
467@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
468@c FIXME... format to come out better.
469@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 470 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 471 the conditions.
5d161b24 472There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
473 for details.
474
475@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
476(@value{GDBP})
477@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
478
479@noindent
480@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
481rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
482We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
483that examples fit in this manual.
484
485@smallexample
486(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
487@end smallexample
488
489@noindent
490We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
491Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
492@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
493@code{break} command.
494
495@smallexample
496(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
497Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
498@end smallexample
499
500@noindent
501Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
502control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
503subroutine, the program runs as usual:
504
505@smallexample
506(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
507Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
508@b{define(foo,0000)}
509
510@b{foo}
5110000
512@end smallexample
513
514@noindent
515To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
516suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
517context where it stops.
518
519@smallexample
520@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
521
5d161b24 522Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
523 at builtin.c:879
524879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
525@end smallexample
526
527@noindent
528Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
529the next line of the current function.
530
531@smallexample
532(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
533882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
534 : nil,
535@end smallexample
536
537@noindent
538@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
539by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
540@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
541subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
542
543@smallexample
544(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
545set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
546 at input.c:530
547530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
548@end smallexample
549
550@noindent
551The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
552suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
553shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
554command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
555in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
556stack frame for each active subroutine.
557
558@smallexample
559(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
560#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
561 at input.c:530
5d161b24 562#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
563 at builtin.c:882
564#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
565#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
566 at macro.c:71
567#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
568#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
569@end smallexample
570
571@noindent
572We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
573times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
574falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
575
576@smallexample
577(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5780x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
579(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5800x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
581def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
582(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
583536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
584 : xstrdup(rq);
585(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
586538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
587@end smallexample
588
589@noindent
590The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
591@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
592and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
593(@code{print}) to see their values.
594
595@smallexample
596(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
597$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
598(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
599$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
600@end smallexample
601
602@noindent
603@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
604To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
605surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
606
607@smallexample
608(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
609533 xfree(rquote);
610534
611535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
612 : xstrdup (lq);
613536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
614 : xstrdup (rq);
615537
616538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
617539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
618540 @}
619541
620542 void
621@end smallexample
622
623@noindent
624Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
625@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
626
627@smallexample
628(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
629539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
630(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
631540 @}
632(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
633$3 = 9
634(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
635$4 = 7
636@end smallexample
637
638@noindent
639That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
640@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
641@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
642the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
643any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
644assignments.
645
646@smallexample
647(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
648$5 = 7
649(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
650$6 = 9
651@end smallexample
652
653@noindent
654Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
655@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
656executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
657example that caused trouble initially:
658
659@smallexample
660(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
661Continuing.
662
663@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
664
665baz
6660000
667@end smallexample
668
669@noindent
670Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
671problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
672lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
673
674@smallexample
675@b{C-d}
676Program exited normally.
677@end smallexample
678
679@noindent
680The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
681indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
682session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
683
684@smallexample
685(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
686@end smallexample
c906108c 687
6d2ebf8b 688@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
689@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
690
691This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 692The essentials are:
c906108c 693@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 694@item
53a5351d 695type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 696@item
c906108c
SS
697type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
698@end itemize
699
700@menu
701* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
702* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
703* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
704@end menu
705
6d2ebf8b 706@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
707@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
708
c906108c
SS
709Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
710@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
711
712You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
713to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
714
c906108c
SS
715The command-line options described here are designed
716to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 717options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
718
719The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
720specifying an executable program:
721
722@example
723@value{GDBP} @var{program}
724@end example
725
c906108c
SS
726@noindent
727You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
728specified:
729
730@example
731@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
732@end example
733
734You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
735to debug a running process:
736
737@example
738@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
739@end example
740
741@noindent
742would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
743named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
744
c906108c 745Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
746complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
747debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
748``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
749will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 750
96a2c332 751You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
752@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
753
754@smallexample
755@value{GDBP} -silent
756@end smallexample
757
758@noindent
759You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
760options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
761
762@noindent
763Type
764
765@example
766@value{GDBP} -help
767@end example
768
769@noindent
770to display all available options and briefly describe their use
771(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
772
773All options and command line arguments you give are processed
774in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
775@samp{-x} option is used.
776
777
778@menu
c906108c
SS
779* File Options:: Choosing files
780* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
781@end menu
782
6d2ebf8b 783@node File Options
c906108c
SS
784@subsection Choosing files
785
2df3850c 786When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
787specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
788the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
789@samp{-c} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the first argument
790that does not have an associated option flag as equivalent to the
791@samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the second argument
792that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as equivalent to
793the @samp{-c} option followed by that argument.)
7a292a7a
SS
794
795If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
796such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
797argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
798
799Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
800following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
801them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
802(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
803than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
804
d700128c
EZ
805@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
806@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
807@c it.
808
c906108c
SS
809@table @code
810@item -symbols @var{file}
811@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
812@cindex @code{--symbols}
813@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
814Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
815
816@item -exec @var{file}
817@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
818@cindex @code{--exec}
819@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
820Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
821and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
822
823@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 824@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
825Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
826file.
827
c906108c
SS
828@item -core @var{file}
829@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
830@cindex @code{--core}
831@cindex @code{-c}
c906108c
SS
832Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
833
834@item -c @var{number}
835Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command
836(unless there is a file in core-dump format named @var{number}, in which
837case @samp{-c} specifies that file as a core dump to read).
c906108c
SS
838
839@item -command @var{file}
840@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
841@cindex @code{--command}
842@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
843Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
844Files,, Command files}.
845
846@item -directory @var{directory}
847@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
848@cindex @code{--directory}
849@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
850Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
851
c906108c
SS
852@item -m
853@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
854@cindex @code{--mapped}
855@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
856@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
857supported on all systems.}@*
858If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 859system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
860to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
861program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 862called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
863Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
864and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
865the symbol table from the executable program.
866
867The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
868is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
869table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 870
c906108c
SS
871@item -r
872@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
873@cindex @code{--readnow}
874@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
875Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
876the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
877This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 878
c906108c
SS
879@end table
880
2df3850c 881You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 882order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
883information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
884on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
885but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c
SS
886
887@example
2df3850c 888gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
c906108c 889@end example
c906108c 890
6d2ebf8b 891@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
892@subsection Choosing modes
893
894You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
895batch mode or quiet mode.
896
897@table @code
898@item -nx
899@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
900@cindex @code{--nx}
901@cindex @code{-n}
2df3850c
JM
902Do not execute commands found in any initialization files (normally
903called @file{.gdbinit}, or @file{gdb.ini} on PCs). Normally,
904@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
905options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
906files}.
c906108c
SS
907
908@item -quiet
d700128c 909@itemx -silent
c906108c 910@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
911@cindex @code{--quiet}
912@cindex @code{--silent}
913@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
914``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
915messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
916
917@item -batch
d700128c 918@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
919Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
920command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
921initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
922nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
923in the command files.
924
2df3850c
JM
925Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
926example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
927make this more useful, the message
c906108c
SS
928
929@example
930Program exited normally.
931@end example
932
933@noindent
2df3850c
JM
934(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
935@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
936mode.
937
938@item -nowindows
939@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
940@cindex @code{--nowindows}
941@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 942``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 943(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
944interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
945
946@item -windows
947@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
948@cindex @code{--windows}
949@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
950If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
951used if possible.
c906108c
SS
952
953@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 954@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
955Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
956instead of the current directory.
957
c906108c
SS
958@item -fullname
959@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
960@cindex @code{--fullname}
961@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
962@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
963subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
964number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
965displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
966recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
967the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
968and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
969@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
970frame.
c906108c 971
d700128c
EZ
972@item -epoch
973@cindex @code{--epoch}
974The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
975@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
976routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
977separate window.
978
979@item -annotate @var{level}
980@cindex @code{--annotate}
981This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
982effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
983(@pxref{Annotations}).
984Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
985together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
986types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
987@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
988maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
989
990@item -async
991@cindex @code{--async}
992Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
993@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
994special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
995commands in parallel with the debugged process being
996run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
997MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
998suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
999control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
b37052ae 1000(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
d700128c
EZ
1001operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1002yet.)
1003@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1004@c should be removed.
1005
1006When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1007uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1008@samp{-noasync} option.
1009
1010@item -noasync
1011@cindex @code{--noasync}
1012Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1013
2df3850c
JM
1014@item -baud @var{bps}
1015@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1016@cindex @code{--baud}
1017@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1018Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1019interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1020
1021@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1022@itemx -t @var{device}
1023@cindex @code{--tty}
1024@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1025Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1026@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1027
53a5351d
JM
1028@c resolve the situation of these eventually
1029@c @item -tui
d700128c 1030@c @cindex @code{--tui}
53a5351d
JM
1031@c Use a Terminal User Interface. For information, use your Web browser to
1032@c read the file @file{TUI.html}, which is usually installed in the
1033@c directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX systems. Do not use
1034@c this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (see @pxref{Emacs, ,Using
1035@c @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1036
1037@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1038@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1039@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1040@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1041@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1042@c systems.
1043
d700128c
EZ
1044@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1045@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1046Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1047program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1048communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end. For example,
1049@samp{--interpreter=mi} causes @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdbmi
7162c0ca 1050interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}).
d700128c
EZ
1051
1052@item -write
1053@cindex @code{--write}
1054Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1055is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1056(@pxref{Patching}).
1057
1058@item -statistics
1059@cindex @code{--statistics}
1060This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1061memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1062
1063@item -version
1064@cindex @code{--version}
1065This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1066no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1067
c906108c
SS
1068@end table
1069
6d2ebf8b 1070@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1071@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1072@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1073@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1074
1075@table @code
1076@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1077@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1078@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1079@itemx q
1080To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1081@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1082do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1083otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1084error code.
c906108c
SS
1085@end table
1086
1087@cindex interrupt
1088An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1089terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1090returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1091character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1092until a time when it is safe.
1093
c906108c
SS
1094If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1095device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1096(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1097
6d2ebf8b 1098@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1099@section Shell commands
1100
1101If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1102debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1103just use the @code{shell} command.
1104
1105@table @code
1106@kindex shell
1107@cindex shell escape
1108@item shell @var{command string}
1109Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1110If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1111shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1112(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1113@end table
1114
1115The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1116You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1117@value{GDBN}:
1118
1119@table @code
1120@kindex make
1121@cindex calling make
1122@item make @var{make-args}
1123Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1124arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1125@end table
1126
6d2ebf8b 1127@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1128@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1129
1130You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1131name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1132@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1133key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1134show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1135
1136@menu
1137* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1138* Completion:: Command completion
1139* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1140@end menu
1141
6d2ebf8b 1142@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1143@section Command syntax
1144
1145A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1146how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1147arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1148command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1149step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1150with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1151
1152@cindex abbreviation
1153@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1154unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1155documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1156abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1157equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1158names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1159arguments to the @code{help} command.
1160
1161@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1162@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1163A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1164repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1165will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1166repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1167repeat.
1168
1169The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1170@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1171exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1172
1173@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1174output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1175(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1176@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1177repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1178
41afff9a 1179@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1180@cindex comment
1181Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1182nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1183Files,,Command files}).
1184
6d2ebf8b 1185@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1186@section Command completion
1187
1188@cindex completion
1189@cindex word completion
1190@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1191only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1192are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1193commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1194
1195Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1196of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1197word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1198enter it). For example, if you type
1199
1200@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1201@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1202@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1203@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1204@example
1205(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1206@end example
1207
1208@noindent
1209@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1210the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1211
1212@example
1213(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1214@end example
1215
1216@noindent
1217You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1218breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1219@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1220were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1221might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1222to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1223
1224If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1225@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1226characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1227@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1228example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1229begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1230just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1231function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1232example:
1233
1234@example
1235(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1236@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1237make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1238make_abs_section make_function_type
1239make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1240make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1241make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1242(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1243@end example
1244
1245@noindent
1246After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1247partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1248command.
1249
1250If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
b37052ae 1251can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1252means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1253key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1254one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1255
1256@cindex quotes in commands
1257@cindex completion of quoted strings
1258Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1259parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1260its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1261situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1262@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1263
c906108c 1264The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
b37052ae
EZ
1265name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1266overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1267by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1268may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1269that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1270that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1271word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1272@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1273@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1274when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
c906108c
SS
1275
1276@example
96a2c332 1277(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1278bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1279(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1280@end example
1281
1282In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1283quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1284completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1285place:
1286
1287@example
1288(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1289@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1290(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1291@end example
1292
1293@noindent
1294In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1295you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1296completion on an overloaded symbol.
1297
d4f3574e 1298For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
b37052ae 1299expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
c906108c 1300overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
b37052ae 1301see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c
SS
1302
1303
6d2ebf8b 1304@node Help
c906108c
SS
1305@section Getting help
1306@cindex online documentation
1307@kindex help
1308
5d161b24 1309You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1310using the command @code{help}.
1311
1312@table @code
41afff9a 1313@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1314@item help
1315@itemx h
1316You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1317display a short list of named classes of commands:
1318
1319@smallexample
1320(@value{GDBP}) help
1321List of classes of commands:
1322
2df3850c 1323aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1324breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1325data -- Examining data
c906108c 1326files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1327internals -- Maintenance commands
1328obscure -- Obscure features
1329running -- Running the program
1330stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1331status -- Status inquiries
1332support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1333tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1334 stopping the program
c906108c 1335user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1336
5d161b24 1337Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1338commands in that class.
5d161b24 1339Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1340documentation.
1341Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1342(@value{GDBP})
1343@end smallexample
96a2c332 1344@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1345
1346@item help @var{class}
1347Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1348list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1349help display for the class @code{status}:
1350
1351@smallexample
1352(@value{GDBP}) help status
1353Status inquiries.
1354
1355List of commands:
1356
1357@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1358@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1359info -- Generic command for showing things
1360 about the program being debugged
1361show -- Generic command for showing things
1362 about the debugger
c906108c 1363
5d161b24 1364Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1365documentation.
1366Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1367(@value{GDBP})
1368@end smallexample
1369
1370@item help @var{command}
1371With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1372short paragraph on how to use that command.
1373
6837a0a2
DB
1374@kindex apropos
1375@item apropos @var{args}
1376The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1377commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1378@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1379
1380@smallexample
1381apropos reload
1382@end smallexample
1383
b37052ae
EZ
1384@noindent
1385results in:
6837a0a2
DB
1386
1387@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1388@c @group
1389set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1390 multiple times in one run
1391show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1392 multiple times in one run
1393@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1394@end smallexample
1395
c906108c
SS
1396@kindex complete
1397@item complete @var{args}
1398The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1399for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1400command you want completed. For example:
1401
1402@smallexample
1403complete i
1404@end smallexample
1405
1406@noindent results in:
1407
1408@smallexample
1409@group
2df3850c
JM
1410if
1411ignore
c906108c
SS
1412info
1413inspect
c906108c
SS
1414@end group
1415@end smallexample
1416
1417@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1418@end table
1419
1420In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1421and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1422of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1423manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1424under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1425all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1426
1427@c @group
1428@table @code
1429@kindex info
41afff9a 1430@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1431@item info
1432This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1433program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1434with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1435registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1436You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1437@w{@code{help info}}.
1438
1439@kindex set
1440@item set
5d161b24 1441You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1442@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1443@code{set prompt $}.
1444
1445@kindex show
1446@item show
5d161b24 1447In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1448@value{GDBN} itself.
1449You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1450related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1451system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1452which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1453
1454@kindex info set
1455To display all the settable parameters and their current
1456values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1457@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1458@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1459@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1460@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1461@end table
1462@c @end group
1463
1464Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1465exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1466
1467@table @code
1468@kindex show version
1469@cindex version number
1470@item show version
1471Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1472information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1473@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1474version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1475commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1476system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1477variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1478The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1479@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1480
1481@kindex show copying
1482@item show copying
1483Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1484
1485@kindex show warranty
1486@item show warranty
2df3850c 1487Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1488if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1489
c906108c
SS
1490@end table
1491
6d2ebf8b 1492@node Running
c906108c
SS
1493@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1494
1495When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1496debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1497
1498You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1499of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1500your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1501kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1502
1503@menu
1504* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1505* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1506* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1507* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1508
1509* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1510* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1511* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1512* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1513
1514* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1515* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1516@end menu
1517
6d2ebf8b 1518@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1519@section Compiling for debugging
1520
1521In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1522debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1523is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1524variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1525and addresses in the executable code.
1526
1527To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1528the compiler.
1529
1530Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1531options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1532executables containing debugging information.
1533
53a5351d
JM
1534@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1535without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1536recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1537program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1538in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1539
1540@cindex optimized code, debugging
1541@cindex debugging optimized code
1542When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1543optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1544really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1545exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1546variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1547variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1548
1549Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1550@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1551doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1552please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1553
1554Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1555@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1556format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1557
1558@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1559@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1560@section Starting your program
1561@cindex starting
1562@cindex running
1563
1564@table @code
1565@kindex run
41afff9a 1566@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1567@item run
1568@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1569Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1570You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1571argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1572@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1573(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1574
1575@end table
1576
c906108c
SS
1577If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1578supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1579that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1580@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1581
1582The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1583receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1584information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1585can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1586your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1587divided into four categories:
1588
1589@table @asis
1590@item The @emph{arguments.}
1591Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1592@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1593is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1594(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1595the arguments.
1596In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1597@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1598@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1599
1600@item The @emph{environment.}
1601Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1602use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1603environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1604your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1605
1606@item The @emph{working directory.}
1607Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1608the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1609@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1610
1611@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1612Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1613standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1614in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1615set a different device for your program.
1616@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1617
1618@cindex pipes
1619@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1620pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1621program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1622wrong program.
1623@end table
c906108c
SS
1624
1625When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1626immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1627of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1628stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1629or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1630
1631If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1632time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1633table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1634your current breakpoints.
1635
6d2ebf8b 1636@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1637@section Your program's arguments
1638
1639@cindex arguments (to your program)
1640The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1641@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1642They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1643performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1644@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1645@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1646the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1647
1648On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1649@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1650calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1651the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1652
1653@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1654@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1655
c906108c 1656@table @code
41afff9a 1657@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1658@item set args
1659Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1660@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1661with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1662using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1663it again without arguments.
1664
1665@kindex show args
1666@item show args
1667Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1668@end table
1669
6d2ebf8b 1670@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1671@section Your program's environment
1672
1673@cindex environment (of your program)
1674The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1675their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1676your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1677path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1678the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1679debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1680environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1681
1682@table @code
1683@kindex path
1684@item path @var{directory}
1685Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
17cc6a06
EZ
1686(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1687The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
d4f3574e
SS
1688You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1689system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1690MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1691is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1692
1693You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1694working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1695use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1696@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1697@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1698@var{directory} to the search path.
1699@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1700@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1701
1702@kindex show paths
1703@item show paths
1704Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1705environment variable).
1706
1707@kindex show environment
1708@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1709Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1710your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1711print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1712your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1713
1714@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1715@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1716Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1717changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1718be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1719any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1720parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1721null value.
1722@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1723@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1724
1725For example, this command:
1726
1727@example
1728set env USER = foo
1729@end example
1730
1731@noindent
d4f3574e 1732tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1733@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1734are not actually required.)
1735
1736@kindex unset environment
1737@item unset environment @var{varname}
1738Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1739program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1740@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1741rather than assigning it an empty value.
1742@end table
1743
d4f3574e
SS
1744@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1745the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1746by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1747@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1748that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1749@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1750your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1751files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1752@file{.profile}.
1753
6d2ebf8b 1754@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1755@section Your program's working directory
1756
1757@cindex working directory (of your program)
1758Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1759working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1760The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1761from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1762working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1763
1764The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1765that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1766specify files}.
1767
1768@table @code
1769@kindex cd
1770@item cd @var{directory}
1771Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1772
1773@kindex pwd
1774@item pwd
1775Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1776@end table
1777
6d2ebf8b 1778@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1779@section Your program's input and output
1780
1781@cindex redirection
1782@cindex i/o
1783@cindex terminal
1784By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1785the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1786to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1787modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1788running your program.
1789
1790@table @code
1791@kindex info terminal
1792@item info terminal
1793Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1794program is using.
1795@end table
1796
1797You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1798redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1799
1800@example
1801run > outfile
1802@end example
1803
1804@noindent
1805starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1806
1807@kindex tty
1808@cindex controlling terminal
1809Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1810with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1811argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1812commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1813process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1814
1815@example
1816tty /dev/ttyb
1817@end example
1818
1819@noindent
1820directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1821default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1822that as their controlling terminal.
1823
1824An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1825effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1826terminal.
1827
1828When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1829command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1830for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1831
6d2ebf8b 1832@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1833@section Debugging an already-running process
1834@kindex attach
1835@cindex attach
1836
1837@table @code
1838@item attach @var{process-id}
1839This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1840outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1841targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1842find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1843or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1844
1845@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1846executing the command.
1847@end table
1848
1849To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1850which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1851programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1852also have permission to send the process a signal.
1853
1854When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1855the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1856the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1857(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1858the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1859Specify Files}.
1860
1861The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1862process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1863with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1864you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1865can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1866process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1867attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1868
1869@table @code
1870@kindex detach
1871@item detach
1872When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1873@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1874the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1875that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1876are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1877@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1878executing the command.
1879@end table
1880
1881If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1882attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1883for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1884control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1885confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1886messages}).
1887
6d2ebf8b 1888@node Kill Process
c906108c 1889@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1890
1891@table @code
1892@kindex kill
1893@item kill
1894Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1895@end table
1896
1897This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1898running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1899is running.
1900
1901On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1902while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1903@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1904outside the debugger.
1905
1906The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1907relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1908executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1909next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1910reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1911breakpoint settings).
1912
6d2ebf8b 1913@node Threads
c906108c 1914@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
1915
1916@cindex threads of execution
1917@cindex multiple threads
1918@cindex switching threads
1919In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
1920may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
1921of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
1922the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
1923that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
1924modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
1925registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
1926
1927@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
1928programs:
1929
1930@itemize @bullet
1931@item automatic notification of new threads
1932@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
1933@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 1934@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
1935a command to apply a command to a list of threads
1936@item thread-specific breakpoints
1937@end itemize
1938
c906108c
SS
1939@quotation
1940@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
1941@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
1942If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
1943effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
1944from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
1945like this:
1946
1947@smallexample
1948(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1949(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
1950Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
1951see the IDs of currently known threads.
1952@end smallexample
1953@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
1954@c doesn't support threads"?
1955@end quotation
c906108c
SS
1956
1957@cindex focus of debugging
1958@cindex current thread
1959The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
1960threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
1961control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
1962This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
1963program information from the perspective of the current thread.
1964
41afff9a 1965@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
1966@cindex thread identifier (system)
1967@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1968@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1969@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1970Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1971the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1972form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1973whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1974LynxOS, you might see
1975
1976@example
1977[New process 35 thread 27]
1978@end example
1979
1980@noindent
1981when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
1982the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
1983further qualifier.
1984
1985@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
1986@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
1987@c second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
1988@c program?
1989@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
1990@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 1991@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
1992
1993@cindex thread number
1994@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1995For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1996number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
1997
1998@table @code
1999@kindex info threads
2000@item info threads
2001Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2002program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2003
2004@enumerate
2005@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2006
2007@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2008
2009@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2010@end enumerate
2011
2012@noindent
2013An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2014indicates the current thread.
2015
5d161b24 2016For example,
c906108c
SS
2017@end table
2018@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2019
2020@smallexample
2021(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2022 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2023 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2024* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2025 at threadtest.c:68
2026@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2027
2028On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2029
2030@cindex thread number
2031@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2032For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2033number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2034thread in your program.
2035
41afff9a
EZ
2036@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2037@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2038@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2039@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2040@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2041Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2042both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2043form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2044whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2045HP-UX, you see
2046
2047@example
2048[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2049@end example
2050
2051@noindent
5d161b24 2052when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2053
2054@table @code
2055@kindex info threads
2056@item info threads
2057Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2058program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2059
2060@enumerate
2061@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2062
2063@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2064
2065@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2066@end enumerate
2067
2068@noindent
2069An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2070indicates the current thread.
2071
5d161b24 2072For example,
c906108c
SS
2073@end table
2074@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2075
2076@example
2077(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2078 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2079 at quicksort.c:137
2080 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2081 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2082 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2083 from /usr/lib/libc.2
c906108c 2084@end example
c906108c
SS
2085
2086@table @code
2087@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2088@item thread @var{threadno}
2089Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2090argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2091shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2092@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2093you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2094
2095@smallexample
2096@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2097(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2098[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
20990x34e5 in sigpause ()
2100@end smallexample
2101
2102@noindent
2103As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2104@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2105threads.
c906108c
SS
2106
2107@kindex thread apply
2108@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2109The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2110more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2111with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2112@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2113threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2114@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2115@end table
2116
2117@cindex automatic thread selection
2118@cindex switching threads automatically
2119@cindex threads, automatic switching
2120Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2121signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2122signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2123message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2124thread.
2125
2126@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2127more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2128programs with multiple threads.
2129
2130@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2131watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2132
6d2ebf8b 2133@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2134@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2135
2136@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2137@cindex multiple processes
2138@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2139On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2140programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2141function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2142parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2143set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2144will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2145will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2146
2147However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2148which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2149the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2150only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2151so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2152on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2153get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2154@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2155the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2156the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2157
53a5351d
JM
2158On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2159debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2160@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2161
2162By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2163the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2164
2165If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2166use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2167
2168@table @code
2169@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2170@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2171Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2172@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2173process. The @var{mode} can be:
2174
2175@table @code
2176@item parent
2177The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2178unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2179
2180@item child
2181The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2182unimpeded.
2183
2184@item ask
2185The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2186@end table
2187
2188@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2189Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2190@end table
2191
2192If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2193@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2194breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2195@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2196the child process's @code{main}.
2197
2198When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2199child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2200
2201If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2202call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2203use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2204argument.
2205
2206You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2207a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2208Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2209
6d2ebf8b 2210@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2211@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2212
2213The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2214program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2215trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2216
7a292a7a
SS
2217Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2218such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2219@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2220change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2221continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2222ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2223explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2224
2225@table @code
2226@kindex info program
2227@item info program
2228Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2229running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2230@end table
2231
2232@menu
2233* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2234* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2235* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2236* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2237@end menu
2238
6d2ebf8b 2239@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2240@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2241
2242@cindex breakpoints
2243A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2244the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2245control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2246breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2247Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2248should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2249program.
2250
2251In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2252breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2253a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2254is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2255not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2256arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2257
2258@cindex watchpoints
2259@cindex memory tracing
2260@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2261@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2262A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2263when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2264command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2265watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2266any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2267and watchpoints using the same commands.
2268
2269You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2270whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2271Automatic display}.
2272
2273@cindex catchpoints
2274@cindex breakpoint on events
2275A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
b37052ae 2276when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
2277exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2278different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2279catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2280other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2281@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2282
2283@cindex breakpoint numbers
2284@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2285@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2286catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2287starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2288features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2289breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2290@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2291enable it again.
2292
c5394b80
JM
2293@cindex breakpoint ranges
2294@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2295Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2296operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2297@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2298hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2299all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2300
c906108c
SS
2301@menu
2302* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2303* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2304* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2305* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2306* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2307* Conditions:: Break conditions
2308* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2309* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2310* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2311@end menu
2312
6d2ebf8b 2313@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2314@subsection Setting breakpoints
2315
5d161b24 2316@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2317@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2318@c
2319@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2320
2321@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2322@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2323@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2324@cindex latest breakpoint
2325Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2326@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2327number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2328Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2329convenience variables.
2330
2331You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2332
2333@table @code
2334@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2335Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c 2336When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
b37052ae 2337C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
c906108c 2338@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2339
2340@item break +@var{offset}
2341@itemx break -@var{offset}
2342Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2343at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2344(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2345
2346@item break @var{linenum}
2347Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2348The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2349The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2350code on that line.
2351
2352@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2353Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2354
2355@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2356Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2357@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2358superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2359functions.
2360
2361@item break *@var{address}
2362Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2363breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2364information or source files.
2365
2366@item break
2367When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2368the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2369(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2370innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2371returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2372@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2373that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2374@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2375the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2376inside loops.
2377
2378@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2379least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2380would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2381breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2382existed when your program stopped.
2383
2384@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2385Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2386@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2387value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2388@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2389above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2390,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2391
2392@kindex tbreak
2393@item tbreak @var{args}
2394Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2395same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2396way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2397program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2398
c906108c
SS
2399@kindex hbreak
2400@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2401Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2402@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2403breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2404have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2405debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2406changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2407provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2408will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2409address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2410breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2411example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2412@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2413or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2414(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2415
2416@kindex thbreak
2417@item thbreak @var{args}
2418Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2419are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2420the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2421the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2422first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2423command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2424may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2425See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2426
2427@kindex rbreak
2428@cindex regular expression
2429@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2430Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2431@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2432matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2433breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2434the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2435them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2436
2437The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2438like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2439shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2440an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2441@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2442match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2443
b37052ae 2444When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
c906108c
SS
2445breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2446classes.
c906108c
SS
2447
2448@kindex info breakpoints
2449@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2450@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2451@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2452@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2453Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2454not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2455
2456@table @emph
2457@item Breakpoint Numbers
2458@item Type
2459Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2460@item Disposition
2461Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2462@item Enabled or Disabled
2463Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2464that are not enabled.
2465@item Address
2df3850c 2466Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2467@item What
2468Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2469line number.
2470@end table
2471
2472@noindent
2473If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2474the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2475are listed after that.
2476
2477@noindent
2478@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2479number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2480convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2481the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2482listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2483
2484@noindent
2485@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2486has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2487@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2488hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2489was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2490will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2491@end table
2492
2493@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2494your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2495the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2496(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2497
2498@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2499@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2500@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for special
2501purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C programs).
2502These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, starting with
2503@code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2504
2505You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2506@samp{maint info breakpoints}.
2507
2508@table @code
2509@kindex maint info breakpoints
2510@item maint info breakpoints
2511Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
2512breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
2513internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
2514breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
2515is shown:
2516
2517@table @code
2518@item breakpoint
2519Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
2520
2521@item watchpoint
2522Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
2523
2524@item longjmp
2525Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
2526@code{longjmp} calls.
2527
2528@item longjmp resume
2529Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
2530
2531@item until
2532Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
2533
2534@item finish
2535Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
2536
c906108c
SS
2537@item shlib events
2538Shared library events.
53a5351d 2539
c906108c 2540@end table
53a5351d 2541
c906108c
SS
2542@end table
2543
2544
6d2ebf8b 2545@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2546@subsection Setting watchpoints
2547
2548@cindex setting watchpoints
2549@cindex software watchpoints
2550@cindex hardware watchpoints
2551You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2552expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2553this may happen.
2554
2555Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2556hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2557program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2558times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2559catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2560culprit.)
2561
d4f3574e 2562On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2563@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2564hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2565program.
2566
2567@table @code
2568@kindex watch
2569@item watch @var{expr}
2570Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2571is written into by the program and its value changes.
2572
2573@kindex rwatch
2574@item rwatch @var{expr}
2575Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2576
2577@kindex awatch
2578@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2579Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2580by the program.
c906108c
SS
2581
2582@kindex info watchpoints
2583@item info watchpoints
2584This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2585it is the same as @code{info break}.
2586@end table
2587
2588@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2589watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2590value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2591cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2592executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2593statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2594
2595When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2596
2597@example
2598Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2599@end example
2600
2601@noindent
2602if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2603
7be570e7
JM
2604Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2605hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2606value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2607every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2608that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2609hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2610will print a message like this:
2611
2612@smallexample
2613Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2614@end smallexample
2615
2616Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2617data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2618watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2619can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2620cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2621double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2622wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2623into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2624
2625If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2626to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2627Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2628time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2629able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2630warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2631
2632@smallexample
2633Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2634@end smallexample
2635
2636@noindent
2637If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2638
2639The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2640or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2641data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2642hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2643both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2644watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2645@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2646watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2647@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2648Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2649
2650If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2651any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2652kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2653
7be570e7
JM
2654@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2655(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2656they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2657which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2658being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2659and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2660rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2661way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2662@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2663
c906108c
SS
2664@quotation
2665@cindex watchpoints and threads
2666@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2667@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2668usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2669can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2670you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2671thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2672can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2673@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2674the expression.
53a5351d 2675
d4f3574e 2676@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2677@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2678have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2679watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2680single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2681change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2682confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2683software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2684when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2685watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2686@end quotation
c906108c 2687
6d2ebf8b 2688@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2689@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2690@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2691@cindex exception handlers
2692@cindex event handling
2693
2694You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
b37052ae 2695kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
c906108c
SS
2696shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2697
2698@table @code
2699@kindex catch
2700@item catch @var{event}
2701Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2702@table @code
2703@item throw
2704@kindex catch throw
b37052ae 2705The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2706
2707@item catch
2708@kindex catch catch
b37052ae 2709The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2710
2711@item exec
2712@kindex catch exec
2713A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2714
2715@item fork
2716@kindex catch fork
2717A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2718
2719@item vfork
2720@kindex catch vfork
2721A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2722
2723@item load
2724@itemx load @var{libname}
2725@kindex catch load
2726The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2727@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2728
2729@item unload
2730@itemx unload @var{libname}
2731@kindex catch unload
2732The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2733of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2734@end table
2735
2736@item tcatch @var{event}
2737Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2738automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2739
2740@end table
2741
2742Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2743
b37052ae 2744There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
2745(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2746
2747@itemize @bullet
2748@item
2749If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2750control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2751raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2752returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2753simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2754that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2755you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2756disabled within interactive calls.
2757
2758@item
2759You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2760
2761@item
2762You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2763@end itemize
2764
2765@cindex raise exceptions
2766Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2767if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2768stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2769can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2770breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2771out where the exception was raised.
2772
2773To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
b37052ae 2774knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
c906108c
SS
2775raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2776which has the following ANSI C interface:
2777
2778@example
2779 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2780 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2781 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
c906108c
SS
2782@end example
2783
2784@noindent
2785To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2786unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2787(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2788
2789With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2790that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2791a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2792breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2793raised.
2794
2795
6d2ebf8b 2796@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2797@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2798
2799@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2800@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2801It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2802catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2803to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2804breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2805
2806With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2807where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2808delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2809their breakpoint numbers.
2810
2811It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2812automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2813when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2814
2815@table @code
2816@kindex clear
2817@item clear
2818Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2819selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2820the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2821breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2822
2823@item clear @var{function}
2824@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2825Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2826
2827@item clear @var{linenum}
2828@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2829Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2830
2831@cindex delete breakpoints
2832@kindex delete
41afff9a 2833@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2834@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2835Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2836ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2837breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2838confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2839@end table
2840
6d2ebf8b 2841@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2842@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2843
2844@kindex disable breakpoints
2845@kindex enable breakpoints
2846Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2847prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2848it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2849that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2850
2851You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2852the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2853or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2854@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2855catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2856
2857A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2858states of enablement:
2859
2860@itemize @bullet
2861@item
2862Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2863with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2864@item
2865Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2866@item
2867Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2868disabled.
c906108c
SS
2869@item
2870Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2871immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2872set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2873@end itemize
2874
2875You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2876watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2877
2878@table @code
2879@kindex disable breakpoints
2880@kindex disable
41afff9a 2881@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 2882@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2883Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2884listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2885options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2886case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2887@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2888
2889@kindex enable breakpoints
2890@kindex enable
c5394b80 2891@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2892Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2893become effective once again in stopping your program.
2894
c5394b80 2895@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2896Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2897of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2898
c5394b80 2899@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2900Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2901deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2902@end table
2903
d4f3574e
SS
2904@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2905@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2906Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2907,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2908subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2909the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2910breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2911breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2912stepping}.)
2913
6d2ebf8b 2914@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2915@subsection Break conditions
2916@cindex conditional breakpoints
2917@cindex breakpoint conditions
2918
2919@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 2920@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
2921The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2922specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2923breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2924programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2925a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2926and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2927
2928This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2929situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2930when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2931by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2932@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2933
2934Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2935since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2936it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2937and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2938one.
2939
2940Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2941your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2942that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2943format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2944unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2945that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2946program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
2947breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2948conditions for the
c906108c
SS
2949purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2950(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2951
2952Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2953@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2954Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
2955with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 2956
c906108c
SS
2957You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
2958The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
2959@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
2960catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
2961
2962@table @code
2963@kindex condition
2964@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
2965Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
2966watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
2967breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
2968@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
2969@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
2970syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
2971referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
2972symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
2973prints an error message:
2974
2975@example
2976No symbol "foo" in current context.
2977@end example
2978
2979@noindent
c906108c
SS
2980@value{GDBN} does
2981not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
2982command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
2983@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
2984
2985@item condition @var{bnum}
2986Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
2987an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
2988@end table
2989
2990@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
2991A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
2992breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
2993useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
2994count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
2995is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
2996therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
2997ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
2998the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
2999value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3000your program reaches it.
3001
3002@table @code
3003@kindex ignore
3004@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3005Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3006The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3007execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3008takes no action.
3009
3010To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3011a count of zero.
3012
3013When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3014breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3015@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3016Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3017
3018If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3019condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3020@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3021
3022You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3023as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3024is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3025variables}.
3026@end table
3027
3028Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3029
3030
6d2ebf8b 3031@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3032@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3033
3034@cindex breakpoint commands
3035You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3036commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3037example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3038enable other breakpoints.
3039
3040@table @code
3041@kindex commands
3042@kindex end
3043@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3044@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3045@itemx end
3046Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3047themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3048@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3049
3050To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3051follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3052
3053With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3054breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3055recently encountered).
3056@end table
3057
3058Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3059disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3060
3061You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3062use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3063that resumes execution.
3064
3065Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3066execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3067(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3068another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3069ambiguities about which list to execute.
3070
3071@kindex silent
3072If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3073usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3074be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3075then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3076see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3077meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3078
3079The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3080print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3081breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3082
3083For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3084value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3085
3086@example
3087break foo if x>0
3088commands
3089silent
3090printf "x is %d\n",x
3091cont
3092end
3093@end example
3094
3095One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3096you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3097of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3098erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3099to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3100so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3101command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3102
3103@example
3104break 403
3105commands
3106silent
3107set x = y + 4
3108cont
3109end
3110@end example
3111
6d2ebf8b 3112@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3113@subsection Breakpoint menus
3114@cindex overloading
3115@cindex symbol overloading
3116
b37052ae 3117Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
c906108c
SS
3118to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3119This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3120@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3121a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3122something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3123particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3124you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3125waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3126options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3127sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3128@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3129breakpoints.
3130
3131For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3132breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3133We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3134
3135@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3136@smallexample
3137@group
3138(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3139[0] cancel
3140[1] all
3141[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3142[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3143[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3144[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3145[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3146[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3147> 2 4 6
3148Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3149Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3150Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3151Multiple breakpoints were set.
3152Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3153 breakpoints.
3154(@value{GDBP})
3155@end group
3156@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3157
3158@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3159@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3160@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3161@c
3162@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3163@c
d4f3574e
SS
3164Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3165any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3166attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3167@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3168
3169@example
3170Cannot insert breakpoints.
3171The same program may be running in another process.
3172@end example
3173
3174When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3175
3176@enumerate
3177@item
3178Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3179
3180@item
5d161b24 3181Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3182name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3183that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3184Then start your program again.
3185
3186@item
3187Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3188linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3189to nonsharable executables.
3190@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3191@c @end ifclear
3192
d4f3574e
SS
3193A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3194hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3195
3196@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3197@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3198@smallexample
3199Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3200You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3201@end smallexample
3202
3203@noindent
3204This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3205only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3206watchpoints it needs to insert.
3207
3208When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3209hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3210
3211
6d2ebf8b 3212@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3213@section Continuing and stepping
3214
3215@cindex stepping
3216@cindex continuing
3217@cindex resuming execution
3218@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3219completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3220one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3221line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3222particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3223your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3224it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3225@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3226
3227@table @code
3228@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3229@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3230@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3231@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3232@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3233@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3234Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3235any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3236@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3237ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3238@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3239
3240The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3241stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3242@code{continue} is ignored.
3243
d4f3574e
SS
3244The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3245debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3246purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3247@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3248@end table
3249
3250To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3251(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3252calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3253different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3254
3255A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3256(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3257beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3258is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3259and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3260interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3261
3262@table @code
3263@kindex step
41afff9a 3264@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3265@item step
3266Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3267line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3268abbreviated @code{s}.
3269
3270@quotation
3271@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3272@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3273@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3274@c distinction here.
3275@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3276within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3277execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3278debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3279is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3280without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3281below.
3282@end quotation
3283
4a92d011
EZ
3284The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3285line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3286@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3287to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3288the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3289called within the line.
c906108c 3290
d4f3574e
SS
3291Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3292number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3293@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3294on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3295was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3296
3297@item step @var{count}
3298Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3299breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3300@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3301
3302@kindex next
41afff9a 3303@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3304@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3305Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3306This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3307the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3308control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3309that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3310is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3311
3312An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3313
3314
3315@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3316@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3317@c
3318@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3319@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3320@c function are executed without stopping.
3321
d4f3574e
SS
3322The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3323source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3324@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3325
b90a5f51
CF
3326@kindex set step-mode
3327@item set step-mode
3328@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3329@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3330@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3331The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3332stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3333information rather than stepping over it.
3334
4a92d011
EZ
3335This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3336machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3337want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3338
3339@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3340Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3341debug information. This is the default.
3342
c906108c
SS
3343@kindex finish
3344@item finish
3345Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3346returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3347
3348Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3349,Returning from a function}).
3350
3351@kindex until
41afff9a 3352@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3353@item until
3354@itemx u
3355Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3356current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3357stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3358command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3359automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3360than the address of the jump.
3361
3362This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3363though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3364exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3365simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3366through the next iteration.
3367
3368@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3369stack frame.
3370
3371@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3372of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3373example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3374(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3375@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3376
3377@example
3378(@value{GDBP}) f
3379#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3380206 expand_input();
3381(@value{GDBP}) until
3382195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3383@end example
3384
3385This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3386generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3387start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3388written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3389to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3390expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3391statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3392
3393@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3394instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3395argument.
3396
3397@item until @var{location}
3398@itemx u @var{location}
3399Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3400reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3401the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3402,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3403and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3404
3405@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3406@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3407@item stepi
96a2c332 3408@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3409@itemx si
3410Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3411
3412It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3413instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3414instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3415Display,, Automatic display}.
3416
3417An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3418
3419@need 750
3420@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3421@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3422@item nexti
96a2c332 3423@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3424@itemx ni
3425Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3426proceed until the function returns.
3427
3428An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3429@end table
3430
6d2ebf8b 3431@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3432@section Signals
3433@cindex signals
3434
3435A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3436operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3437kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3438signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3439@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3440memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3441the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3442requested an alarm).
3443
3444@cindex fatal signals
3445Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3446functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3447errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3448program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3449@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3450fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3451
3452@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3453program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3454signal.
3455
3456@cindex handling signals
3457Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to ignore non-erroneous signals like @code{SIGALRM}
3458(so as not to interfere with their role in the functioning of your program)
3459but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3460You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3461
3462@table @code
3463@kindex info signals
3464@item info signals
96a2c332 3465@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3466Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3467handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3468the defined types of signals.
3469
d4f3574e 3470@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3471
3472@kindex handle
3473@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5ece1a18
EZ
3474Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3475can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
3476@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numberss of the form
3477@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3478known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
c906108c
SS
3479@end table
3480
3481@c @group
3482The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3483Their full names are:
3484
3485@table @code
3486@item nostop
3487@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3488still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3489
3490@item stop
3491@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3492the @code{print} keyword as well.
3493
3494@item print
3495@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3496
3497@item noprint
3498@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3499implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3500
3501@item pass
5ece1a18 3502@itemx noignore
c906108c
SS
3503@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3504can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5ece1a18 3505and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3506
3507@item nopass
5ece1a18 3508@itemx ignore
c906108c 3509@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5ece1a18 3510@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3511@end table
3512@c @end group
3513
d4f3574e
SS
3514When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3515program until you
c906108c
SS
3516continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3517effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3518after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3519command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3520program sees that signal when you continue.
3521
3522You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3523seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3524or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3525due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3526values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3527execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3528a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3529you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3530program a signal}.
c906108c 3531
6d2ebf8b 3532@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3533@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3534
3535When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3536programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3537breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3538
3539@table @code
3540@cindex breakpoints and threads
3541@cindex thread breakpoints
3542@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3543@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3544@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3545@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3546writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3547
3548Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3549to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3550particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3551numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3552column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3553
3554If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3555breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3556program.
3557
3558You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3559well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3560breakpoint condition, like this:
3561
3562@smallexample
2df3850c 3563(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3564@end smallexample
3565
3566@end table
3567
3568@cindex stopped threads
3569@cindex threads, stopped
3570Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3571@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3572allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3573switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3574underfoot.
3575
3576@cindex continuing threads
3577@cindex threads, continuing
3578Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3579executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3580like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3581
3582In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3583Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3584system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3585execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3586single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3587statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3588stops.
3589
3590You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3591continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3592thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3593first thread completes whatever you requested.
3594
3595On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3596thread to run.
3597
3598@table @code
3599@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3600Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3601locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3602current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3603mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3604``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3605stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3606when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3607function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3608like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3609thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3610@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3611
3612@item show scheduler-locking
3613Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3614@end table
3615
c906108c 3616
6d2ebf8b 3617@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3618@chapter Examining the Stack
3619
3620When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3621stopped and how it got there.
3622
3623@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3624Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3625is generated.
3626That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3627the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3628and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3629The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3630The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3631stack}.
3632
3633When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3634stack allow you to see all of this information.
3635
3636@cindex selected frame
3637One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3638@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3639particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3640your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3641special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3642interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3643
3644When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3645currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3646@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3647
3648@menu
3649* Frames:: Stack frames
3650* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3651* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3652* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3653
3654@end menu
3655
6d2ebf8b 3656@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3657@section Stack frames
3658
d4f3574e 3659@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3660@cindex stack frame
3661The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3662frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3663with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3664to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3665which the function is executing.
3666
3667@cindex initial frame
3668@cindex outermost frame
3669@cindex innermost frame
3670When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3671function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3672@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3673made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3674is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3675the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3676actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3677recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3678
3679@cindex frame pointer
3680Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3681stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3682kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3683address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3684in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3685going on in that frame.
3686
3687@cindex frame number
3688@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3689zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3690and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3691they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3692frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3693
6d2ebf8b
SS
3694@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3695@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3696@cindex frameless execution
3697Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b
SS
3698without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3699@example
3700@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3701@end example
3702generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3703This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3704the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3705with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3706has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3707it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3708correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3709no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3710
3711@table @code
d4f3574e 3712@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3713@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3714@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3715The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3716and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3717address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3718@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3719
3720@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3721@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3722@item select-frame
3723The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3724to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3725@code{frame}.
3726@end table
3727
6d2ebf8b 3728@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3729@section Backtraces
3730
3731@cindex backtraces
3732@cindex tracebacks
3733@cindex stack traces
3734A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3735line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3736frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3737stack.
3738
3739@table @code
3740@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3741@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3742@item backtrace
3743@itemx bt
3744Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3745frames in the stack.
3746
3747You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3748character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3749
3750@item backtrace @var{n}
3751@itemx bt @var{n}
3752Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3753
3754@item backtrace -@var{n}
3755@itemx bt -@var{n}
3756Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3757@end table
3758
3759@kindex where
3760@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3761@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3762The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3763are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3764
3765Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3766The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3767print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3768line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3769counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3770line number.
3771
3772Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3773@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3774
3775@smallexample
3776@group
5d161b24 3777#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3778 at builtin.c:993
3779#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3780#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3781 at macro.c:71
3782(More stack frames follow...)
3783@end group
3784@end smallexample
3785
3786@noindent
3787The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3788value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3789code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3790
6d2ebf8b 3791@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3792@section Selecting a frame
3793
3794Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3795whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3796selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3797of the stack frame just selected.
3798
3799@table @code
d4f3574e 3800@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3801@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3802@item frame @var{n}
3803@itemx f @var{n}
3804Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3805(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3806innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3807@code{main}.
3808
3809@item frame @var{addr}
3810@itemx f @var{addr}
3811Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3812chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3813impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3814addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3815switches between them.
3816
c906108c
SS
3817On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3818select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3819
3820On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3821pointer and a program counter.
3822
3823On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3824pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3825@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3826@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3827@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3828
3829@kindex up
3830@item up @var{n}
3831Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3832advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3833that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3834
3835@kindex down
41afff9a 3836@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3837@item down @var{n}
3838Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3839advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3840that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3841abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3842@end table
3843
3844All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3845frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3846arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3847frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3848
3849@need 1000
3850For example:
3851
3852@smallexample
3853@group
3854(@value{GDBP}) up
3855#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3856 at env.c:10
385710 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3858@end group
3859@end smallexample
3860
3861After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3862prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3863@xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3864
3865@table @code
3866@kindex down-silently
3867@kindex up-silently
3868@item up-silently @var{n}
3869@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3870These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3871respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3872causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3873in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3874distracting.
3875@end table
3876
6d2ebf8b 3877@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
3878@section Information about a frame
3879
3880There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3881stack frame.
3882
3883@table @code
3884@item frame
3885@itemx f
3886When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3887frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3888selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3889argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3890@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3891
3892@kindex info frame
41afff9a 3893@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
3894@item info frame
3895@itemx info f
3896This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3897including:
3898
3899@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
3900@item
3901the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
3902@item
3903the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3904@item
3905the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3906@item
3907the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3908@item
3909the address of the frame's arguments
3910@item
d4f3574e
SS
3911the address of the frame's local variables
3912@item
c906108c
SS
3913the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3914@item
3915which registers were saved in the frame
3916@end itemize
3917
3918@noindent The verbose description is useful when
3919something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3920the usual conventions.
3921
3922@item info frame @var{addr}
3923@itemx info f @var{addr}
3924Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3925selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3926command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3927architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3928@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3929
3930@kindex info args
3931@item info args
3932Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3933
3934@item info locals
3935@kindex info locals
3936Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3937line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3938accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3939
c906108c 3940@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
3941@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3942@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
3943@item info catch
3944Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3945current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3946exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3947@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3948@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 3949
c906108c
SS
3950@end table
3951
c906108c 3952
6d2ebf8b 3953@node Source
c906108c
SS
3954@chapter Examining Source Files
3955
3956@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
3957information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
3958used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
3959the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
3960(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
3961execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
3962source files by explicit command.
3963
7a292a7a 3964If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 3965prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 3966@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
3967
3968@menu
3969* List:: Printing source lines
c906108c 3970* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
3971* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
3972* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
3973@end menu
3974
6d2ebf8b 3975@node List
c906108c
SS
3976@section Printing source lines
3977
3978@kindex list
41afff9a 3979@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 3980To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 3981(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
3982There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
3983
3984Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
3985
3986@table @code
3987@item list @var{linenum}
3988Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
3989current source file.
3990
3991@item list @var{function}
3992Print lines centered around the beginning of function
3993@var{function}.
3994
3995@item list
3996Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
3997@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
3998printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
3999as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4000Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4001
4002@item list -
4003Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4004@end table
4005
4006By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4007the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4008
4009@table @code
4010@kindex set listsize
4011@item set listsize @var{count}
4012Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4013the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4014
4015@kindex show listsize
4016@item show listsize
4017Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4018@end table
4019
4020Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4021so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4022than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4023argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4024each repetition moves up in the source file.
4025
4026@cindex linespec
4027In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4028@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4029of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4030Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4031
4032@table @code
4033@item list @var{linespec}
4034Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4035
4036@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4037Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4038linespecs.
4039
4040@item list ,@var{last}
4041Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4042
4043@item list @var{first},
4044Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4045
4046@item list +
4047Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4048
4049@item list -
4050Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4051
4052@item list
4053As described in the preceding table.
4054@end table
4055
4056Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4057kinds of linespec.
4058
4059@table @code
4060@item @var{number}
4061Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4062When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4063the same source file as the first linespec.
4064
4065@item +@var{offset}
4066Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4067When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4068two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4069first linespec.
4070
4071@item -@var{offset}
4072Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4073
4074@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4075Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4076
4077@item @var{function}
4078Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4079For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4080
4081@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4082Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4083function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4084file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4085identically named functions in different source files.
4086
4087@item *@var{address}
4088Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4089@var{address} may be any expression.
4090@end table
4091
6d2ebf8b 4092@node Search
c906108c
SS
4093@section Searching source files
4094@cindex searching
4095@kindex reverse-search
4096
4097There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4098regular expression.
4099
4100@table @code
4101@kindex search
4102@kindex forward-search
4103@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4104@itemx search @var{regexp}
4105The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4106starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4107@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4108synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4109@code{fo}.
4110
4111@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4112The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4113with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4114for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4115this command as @code{rev}.
4116@end table
c906108c 4117
6d2ebf8b 4118@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4119@section Specifying source directories
4120
4121@cindex source path
4122@cindex directories for source files
4123Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4124files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4125the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4126session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4127this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4128it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4129in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4130the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4131the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4132path.
4133
4134If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4135object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4136too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4137compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4138last resort.
4139
4140Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4141any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4142each line is in the file.
4143
4144@kindex directory
4145@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4146When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4147and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4148To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4149
4150@table @code
4151@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4152@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4153Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4154directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4155(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4156part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4157whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4158path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4159
4160@kindex cdir
4161@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4162@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4163@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4164@cindex compilation directory
4165@cindex current directory
4166@cindex working directory
4167@cindex directory, current
4168@cindex directory, compilation
4169You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4170directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4171working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4172tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4173session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4174directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4175
4176@item directory
4177Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4178
4179@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4180@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4181
4182@item show directories
4183@kindex show directories
4184Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4185@end table
4186
4187If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4188interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4189versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4190
4191@enumerate
4192@item
4193Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4194
4195@item
4196Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4197directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4198directories in one command.
4199@end enumerate
4200
6d2ebf8b 4201@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4202@section Source and machine code
4203
4204You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4205addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4206a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4207mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4208line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4209well as hex.
4210
4211@table @code
4212@kindex info line
4213@item info line @var{linespec}
4214Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4215source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4216the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4217source lines}).
4218@end table
4219
4220For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4221the object code for the first line of function
4222@code{m4_changequote}:
4223
d4f3574e
SS
4224@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4225@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4226@smallexample
96a2c332 4227(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4228Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4229@end smallexample
4230
4231@noindent
4232We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4233@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4234@smallexample
4235(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4236Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4237@end smallexample
4238
4239@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4240@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4241After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4242is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4243sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4244,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4245convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4246variables}).
4247
4248@table @code
4249@kindex disassemble
4250@cindex assembly instructions
4251@cindex instructions, assembly
4252@cindex machine instructions
4253@cindex listing machine instructions
4254@item disassemble
4255This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4256instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4257program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4258command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4259surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4260(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4261@end table
4262
c906108c
SS
4263The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4264HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4265
4266@smallexample
4267(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4268Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
42690x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
42700x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
42710x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
42720x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
42730x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
42740x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
42750x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
42760x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4277End of assembler dump.
4278@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4279
4280Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4281mnemonics or other syntax.
4282
4283@table @code
d4f3574e 4284@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4285@cindex assembly instructions
4286@cindex instructions, assembly
4287@cindex machine instructions
4288@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4289@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4290@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4291@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4292Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4293program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4294
4295Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4296can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4297The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4298assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4299@end table
4300
4301
6d2ebf8b 4302@node Data
c906108c
SS
4303@chapter Examining Data
4304
4305@cindex printing data
4306@cindex examining data
4307@kindex print
4308@kindex inspect
4309@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4310@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4311@c different window or something like that.
4312The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4313command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4314evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4315program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4316Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4317
4318@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4319@item print @var{expr}
4320@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4321@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4322value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4323you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4324@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4325formats}.
4326
4327@item print
4328@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4329If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4330@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4331conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4332@end table
4333
4334A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4335It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4336specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4337
7a292a7a 4338If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4339fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4340command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4341Table}.
c906108c
SS
4342
4343@menu
4344* Expressions:: Expressions
4345* Variables:: Program variables
4346* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4347* Output Formats:: Output formats
4348* Memory:: Examining memory
4349* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4350* Print Settings:: Print settings
4351* Value History:: Value history
4352* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4353* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4354* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
29e57380 4355* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
c906108c
SS
4356@end menu
4357
6d2ebf8b 4358@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4359@section Expressions
4360
4361@cindex expressions
4362@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4363compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4364by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4365@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4366and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4367by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4368
d4f3574e
SS
4369@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4370the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4371you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4372memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4373
c906108c
SS
4374Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4375this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4376Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4377languages.
4378
4379In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4380expressions regardless of your programming language.
4381
4382Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4383useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4384at that address in memory.
4385@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4386
4387@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4388to programming languages:
4389
4390@table @code
4391@item @@
4392@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4393@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4394
4395@item ::
4396@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4397function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4398
4399@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4400@cindex type casting memory
4401@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4402@cindex casts, to view memory
4403@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4404Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4405memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4406pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4407a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4408normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4409@end table
4410
6d2ebf8b 4411@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4412@section Program variables
4413
4414The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4415in your program.
4416
4417Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4418(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4419
4420@itemize @bullet
4421@item
4422global (or file-static)
4423@end itemize
4424
5d161b24 4425@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4426
4427@itemize @bullet
4428@item
4429visible according to the scope rules of the
4430programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4431@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4432
4433@noindent This means that in the function
4434
4435@example
4436foo (a)
4437 int a;
4438@{
4439 bar (a);
4440 @{
4441 int b = test ();
4442 bar (b);
4443 @}
4444@}
4445@end example
4446
4447@noindent
4448you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4449executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4450examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4451the block where @code{b} is declared.
4452
4453@cindex variable name conflict
4454There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4455scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4456in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4457function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4458happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4459you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4460using the colon-colon notation:
4461
d4f3574e 4462@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4463@iftex
4464@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4465@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4466@end iftex
4467@example
4468@var{file}::@var{variable}
4469@var{function}::@var{variable}
4470@end example
4471
4472@noindent
4473Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4474static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4475make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4476to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4477
4478@example
4479(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4480@end example
4481
b37052ae 4482@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
c906108c 4483This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
b37052ae 4484use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
4485scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4486@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4487@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4488
4489@cindex wrong values
4490@cindex variable values, wrong
4491@quotation
4492@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4493wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4494scope, and just before exit.
4495@end quotation
4496You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4497This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4498set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4499stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4500values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4501also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4502after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4503variable definitions may be gone.
4504
4505This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4506To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4507when compiling.
4508
d4f3574e
SS
4509@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4510Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4511unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4512opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4513offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4514might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4515happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4516
4517@example
4518No symbol "foo" in current context.
4519@end example
4520
4521To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4522different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
b37052ae 4523formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler usually
d4f3574e
SS
4524supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4525in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
96c405b3 4526to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
d4f3574e
SS
4527debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4528Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4529information.
4530
4531
6d2ebf8b 4532@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4533@section Artificial arrays
4534
4535@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4536@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4537It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4538same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4539dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4540program.
4541
4542You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4543@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4544operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4545and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4546of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4547the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4548argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4549following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4550example. If a program says
4551
4552@example
4553int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4554@end example
4555
4556@noindent
4557you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4558
4559@example
4560p *array@@len
4561@end example
4562
4563The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4564with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4565subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4566Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4567(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4568
4569Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4570This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4571The value need not be in memory:
4572@example
4573(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4574$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4575@end example
4576
4577As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4578@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c
SS
4579the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4580@example
4581(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4582$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4583@end example
4584
4585Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4586moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4587actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4588of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4589to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4590variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4591interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4592instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4593structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4594in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4595
4596@example
4597set $i = 0
4598p dtab[$i++]->fv
4599@key{RET}
4600@key{RET}
4601@dots{}
4602@end example
4603
6d2ebf8b 4604@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4605@section Output formats
4606
4607@cindex formatted output
4608@cindex output formats
4609By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4610this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4611in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4612at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4613these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4614
4615The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4616already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4617@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4618letters supported are:
4619
4620@table @code
4621@item x
4622Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4623hexadecimal.
4624
4625@item d
4626Print as integer in signed decimal.
4627
4628@item u
4629Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4630
4631@item o
4632Print as integer in octal.
4633
4634@item t
4635Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4636@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4637used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4638see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4639
4640@item a
4641@cindex unknown address, locating
3d67e040 4642@cindex locate address
c906108c
SS
4643Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4644the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4645where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4646
4647@example
4648(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4649$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4650@end example
4651
3d67e040
EZ
4652@noindent
4653The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4654@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4655
c906108c
SS
4656@item c
4657Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4658
4659@item f
4660Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4661using typical floating point syntax.
4662@end table
4663
4664For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4665
4666@example
4667p/x $pc
4668@end example
4669
4670@noindent
4671Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4672names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4673
4674To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4675you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4676expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4677
6d2ebf8b 4678@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4679@section Examining memory
4680
4681You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4682any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4683
4684@cindex examining memory
4685@table @code
41afff9a 4686@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4687@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4688@itemx x @var{addr}
4689@itemx x
4690Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4691@end table
4692
4693@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4694much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4695expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4696If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4697Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4698
4699@table @r
4700@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4701The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4702how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4703@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4704@c 4.1.2.
4705
4706@item @var{f}, the display format
4707The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4708@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4709The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4710The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4711
4712@item @var{u}, the unit size
4713The unit size is any of
4714
4715@table @code
4716@item b
4717Bytes.
4718@item h
4719Halfwords (two bytes).
4720@item w
4721Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4722@item g
4723Giant words (eight bytes).
4724@end table
4725
4726Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4727default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4728@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4729
4730@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4731@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4732memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4733it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4734@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4735@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4736other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4737the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4738starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4739a value from memory).
4740@end table
4741
4742For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4743(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4744starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4745words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4746@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4747
4748Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4749letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4750unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4751specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4752(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4753
4754Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4755and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4756@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4757including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4758alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4759Code,,Source and machine code}.
4760
4761All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4762easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4763you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4764instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4765with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4766the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4767for successive uses of @code{x}.
4768
4769@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4770The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4771in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4772would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4773subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4774@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4775examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4776@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4777the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4778
4779If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4780are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4781address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4782
6d2ebf8b 4783@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4784@section Automatic display
4785@cindex automatic display
4786@cindex display of expressions
4787
4788If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4789(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4790display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4791Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4792to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4793The automatic display looks like this:
4794
4795@example
47962: foo = 38
47973: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4798@end example
4799
4800@noindent
4801This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4802displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4803specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4804whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4805format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4806or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4807supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4808
4809@table @code
4810@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4811@item display @var{expr}
4812Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4813each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4814
4815@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4816
d4f3574e 4817@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4818For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4819count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4820arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4821@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4822
4823@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4824For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4825number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4826be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4827doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4828@end table
4829
4830For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4831instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4832is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4833
4834@table @code
4835@kindex delete display
4836@kindex undisplay
4837@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4838@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4839Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4840
4841@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4842(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4843
4844@kindex disable display
4845@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4846Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4847item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4848enabled again later.
4849
4850@kindex enable display
4851@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4852Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4853again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4854
4855@item display
4856Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4857done when your program stops.
4858
4859@kindex info display
4860@item info display
4861Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4862automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4863values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4864It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4865because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4866@end table
4867
4868If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4869sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4870expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4871variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4872@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4873@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4874continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4875there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4876automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4877is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4878
6d2ebf8b 4879@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
4880@section Print settings
4881
4882@cindex format options
4883@cindex print settings
4884@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4885and symbols are printed.
4886
4887@noindent
4888These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4889
4890@table @code
4891@kindex set print address
4892@item set print address
4893@itemx set print address on
4894@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4895traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4896even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4897is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4898@code{set print address on}:
4899
4900@smallexample
4901@group
4902(@value{GDBP}) f
4903#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4904 at input.c:530
4905530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4906@end group
4907@end smallexample
4908
4909@item set print address off
4910Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4911this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4912
4913@smallexample
4914@group
4915(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4916(@value{GDBP}) f
4917#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4918530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4919@end group
4920@end smallexample
4921
4922You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4923dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4924@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4925all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4926
4927@kindex show print address
4928@item show print address
4929Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4930@end table
4931
4932When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4933closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4934identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4935source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4936@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4937you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4938it prints a symbolic address:
4939
4940@table @code
4941@kindex set print symbol-filename
4942@item set print symbol-filename on
4943Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4944symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4945
4946@item set print symbol-filename off
4947Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
4948default.
4949
4950@kindex show print symbol-filename
4951@item show print symbol-filename
4952Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
4953line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4954@end table
4955
4956Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
4957numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
4958number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
4959
4960Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
4961printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
4962
4963@table @code
4964@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
4965@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
4966Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
4967offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 4968@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
4969to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
4970
4971@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
4972@item show print max-symbolic-offset
4973Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
4974symbolic address.
4975@end table
4976
4977@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
4978@cindex pointer, finding referent
4979If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
4980@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
4981and source file location of the variable where it points, using
4982@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
4983For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
4984at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
4985
4986@example
4987(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
4988(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
4989$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
4990@end example
4991
4992@quotation
4993@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
4994does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
4995the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
4996@end quotation
4997
4998Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
4999
5000@table @code
5001@kindex set print array
5002@item set print array
5003@itemx set print array on
5004Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5005but uses more space. The default is off.
5006
5007@item set print array off
5008Return to compressed format for arrays.
5009
5010@kindex show print array
5011@item show print array
5012Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5013arrays.
5014
5015@kindex set print elements
5016@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5017Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5018If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5019printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5020This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5021When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5022Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5023
5024@kindex show print elements
5025@item show print elements
5026Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5027If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5028
5029@kindex set print null-stop
5030@item set print null-stop
5031Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5032@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5033contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5034The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5035
5036@kindex set print pretty
5037@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5038Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5039per line, like this:
5040
5041@smallexample
5042@group
5043$1 = @{
5044 next = 0x0,
5045 flags = @{
5046 sweet = 1,
5047 sour = 1
5048 @},
5049 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5050@}
5051@end group
5052@end smallexample
5053
5054@item set print pretty off
5055Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5056
5057@smallexample
5058@group
5059$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5060meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5061@end group
5062@end smallexample
5063
5064@noindent
5065This is the default format.
5066
5067@kindex show print pretty
5068@item show print pretty
5069Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5070
5071@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5072@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5073Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5074@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5075character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5076best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5077high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5078
5079@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5080Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5081international character sets, and is the default.
5082
5083@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5084@item show print sevenbit-strings
5085Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5086
5087@kindex set print union
5088@item set print union on
5d161b24 5089Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5090is the default setting.
5091
5092@item set print union off
5093Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5094
5095@kindex show print union
5096@item show print union
5097Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5098structures.
5099
5100For example, given the declarations
5101
5102@smallexample
5103typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5104typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5105typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5106 Bug_forms;
5107
5108struct thing @{
5109 Species it;
5110 union @{
5111 Tree_forms tree;
5112 Bug_forms bug;
5113 @} form;
5114@};
5115
5116struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5117@end smallexample
5118
5119@noindent
5120with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5121
5122@smallexample
5123$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5124@end smallexample
5125
5126@noindent
5127and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5128
5129@smallexample
5130$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5131@end smallexample
5132@end table
5133
c906108c
SS
5134@need 1000
5135@noindent
b37052ae 5136These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
c906108c
SS
5137
5138@table @code
5139@cindex demangling
5140@kindex set print demangle
5141@item set print demangle
5142@itemx set print demangle on
b37052ae 5143Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
c906108c 5144(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5145linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5146
5147@kindex show print demangle
5148@item show print demangle
b37052ae 5149Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
c906108c
SS
5150
5151@kindex set print asm-demangle
5152@item set print asm-demangle
5153@itemx set print asm-demangle on
b37052ae 5154Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
c906108c
SS
5155in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5156The default is off.
5157
5158@kindex show print asm-demangle
5159@item show print asm-demangle
b37052ae 5160Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
c906108c
SS
5161or demangled form.
5162
5163@kindex set demangle-style
b37052ae
EZ
5164@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5165@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
5166@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5167Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
b37052ae 5168represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
c906108c
SS
5169
5170@table @code
5171@item auto
5172Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5173
5174@item gnu
b37052ae 5175Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5176This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5177
5178@item hp
b37052ae 5179Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5180
5181@item lucid
b37052ae 5182Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5183
5184@item arm
b37052ae 5185Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
c906108c
SS
5186@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5187debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5188require further enhancement to permit that.
5189
5190@end table
5191If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5192
5193@kindex show demangle-style
5194@item show demangle-style
b37052ae 5195Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
c906108c
SS
5196
5197@kindex set print object
5198@item set print object
5199@itemx set print object on
5200When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5201(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5202the virtual function table.
5203
5204@item set print object off
5205Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5206virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5207
5208@kindex show print object
5209@item show print object
5210Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5211
5212@kindex set print static-members
5213@item set print static-members
5214@itemx set print static-members on
b37052ae 5215Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5216
5217@item set print static-members off
b37052ae 5218Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
c906108c
SS
5219
5220@kindex show print static-members
5221@item show print static-members
b37052ae 5222Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
c906108c
SS
5223
5224@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5225@kindex set print vtbl
5226@item set print vtbl
5227@itemx set print vtbl on
b37052ae 5228Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c 5229(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 5230ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5231
5232@item set print vtbl off
b37052ae 5233Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
c906108c
SS
5234
5235@kindex show print vtbl
5236@item show print vtbl
b37052ae 5237Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
c906108c 5238@end table
c906108c 5239
6d2ebf8b 5240@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5241@section Value history
5242
5243@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5244Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5245@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5246Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5247(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5248When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5249since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5250symbol table.
5251
5252@cindex @code{$}
5253@cindex @code{$$}
5254@cindex history number
5255The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5256refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5257@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5258printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5259history number.
5260
5261To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5262history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5263remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5264the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5265@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5266is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5267@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5268
5269For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5270want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5271
5272@example
5273p *$
5274@end example
5275
5276If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5277to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5278
5279@example
5280p *$.next
5281@end example
5282
5283@noindent
5284You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5285command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5286
5287Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5288@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5289
5290@example
5291print x
5292set x=5
5293@end example
5294
5295@noindent
5296then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5297remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5298
5299@table @code
5300@kindex show values
5301@item show values
5302Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5303This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5304values} does not change the history.
5305
5306@item show values @var{n}
5307Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5308
5309@item show values +
5310Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5311values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5312@end table
5313
5314Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5315same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5316
6d2ebf8b 5317@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5318@section Convenience variables
5319
5320@cindex convenience variables
5321@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5322@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5323exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5324setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5325of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5326
5327Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5328@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5329the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5330(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5331by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5332
5333You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5334expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5335For example:
5336
5337@example
5338set $foo = *object_ptr
5339@end example
5340
5341@noindent
5342would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5343@code{object_ptr}.
5344
5345Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5346value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5347value with another assignment at any time.
5348
5349Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5350variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5351that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5352variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5353
5354@table @code
5355@kindex show convenience
5356@item show convenience
5357Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5358Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5359@end table
5360
5361One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5362incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5363a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5364
5365@example
5366set $i = 0
5367print bar[$i++]->contents
5368@end example
5369
d4f3574e
SS
5370@noindent
5371Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5372
5373Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5374values likely to be useful.
5375
5376@table @code
41afff9a 5377@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5378@item $_
5379The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5380the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5381commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5382set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5383and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5384except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5385to the type of @code{$__}.
5386
41afff9a 5387@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5388@item $__
5389The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5390to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5391to match the format in which the data was printed.
5392
5393@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5394@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5395The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5396the program being debugged terminates.
5397@end table
5398
53a5351d
JM
5399On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5400begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5401name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5402
6d2ebf8b 5403@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5404@section Registers
5405
5406@cindex registers
5407You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5408with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5409for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5410your machine.
5411
5412@table @code
5413@kindex info registers
5414@item info registers
5415Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5416registers (in the selected stack frame).
5417
5418@kindex info all-registers
5419@cindex floating point registers
5420@item info all-registers
5421Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5422registers.
5423
5424@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5425Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5426As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5427the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5428the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5429@end table
5430
5431@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5432expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5433architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5434@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5435the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5436pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5437register that contains the processor status. For example,
5438you could print the program counter in hex with
5439
5440@example
5441p/x $pc
5442@end example
5443
5444@noindent
5445or print the instruction to be executed next with
5446
5447@example
5448x/i $pc
5449@end example
5450
5451@noindent
5452or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5453one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5454memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5455stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5456stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5457regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5458see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c
SS
5459
5460@example
5461set $sp += 4
5462@end example
5463
5464Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5465your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5466so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5467shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5468registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5469can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5470is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5471
5472@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5473integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5474special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5475registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5476to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5477(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5478@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5479
5480Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5481means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5482the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5483sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5484coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5485programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5486cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5487that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5488prints the data in both formats.
5489
5490Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5491(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5492value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5493were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5494true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5495frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5496
5497However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5498code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5499@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5500frame makes no difference.
5501
6d2ebf8b 5502@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5503@section Floating point hardware
5504@cindex floating point
5505
5506Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5507you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5508
5509@table @code
5510@kindex info float
5511@item info float
5512Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5513point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5514floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5515the ARM and x86 machines.
5516@end table
c906108c 5517
29e57380
C
5518@node Memory Region Attributes
5519@section Memory Region Attributes
5520@cindex memory region attributes
5521
5522@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5523required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5524to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5525use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5526
5527Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5528memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5529accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5530been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5531all memory.
5532
5533When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5534to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5535
5536@table @code
5537@kindex mem
5538@item mem @var{address1} @var{address1} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5539Define memory region bounded by @var{address1} and @var{address2}
5540with attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}.
5541
5542@kindex delete mem
5543@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5544Remove memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5545
5546@kindex disable mem
5547@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5548Disable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5549A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5550It may be enabled again later.
5551
5552@kindex enable mem
5553@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5554Enable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5555
5556@kindex info mem
5557@item info mem
5558Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5559for each region.
5560
5561@table @emph
5562@item Memory Region Number
5563@item Enabled or Disabled.
5564Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5565Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5566
5567@item Lo Address
5568The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5569
5570@item Hi Address
5571The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5572
5573@item Attributes
5574The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5575@end table
5576@end table
5577
5578
5579@subsection Attributes
5580
5581@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5582The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5583write accesses to a memory region.
5584
5585While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5586memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5587etc. from accessing memory.
5588
5589@table @code
5590@item ro
5591Memory is read only.
5592@item wo
5593Memory is write only.
5594@item rw
5595Memory is read/write (default).
5596@end table
5597
5598@subsubsection Memory Access Size
5599The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5600accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5601require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5602specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5603
5604@table @code
5605@item 8
5606Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5607@item 16
5608Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5609@item 32
5610Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5611@item 64
5612Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5613@end table
5614
5615@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5616@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5617@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5618@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5619@c
5620@c @table @code
5621@c @item hwbreak
5622@c Always use hardware breakpoints
5623@c @item swbreak (default)
5624@c @end table
5625
5626@subsubsection Data Cache
5627The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5628memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5629protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5630does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5631registers.
5632
5633@table @code
5634@item cache
5635Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
5636@item nocache (default)
5637Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory.
5638@end table
5639
5640@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5641@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5642@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5643@c
5644@c @table @code
5645@c @item verify
5646@c @item noverify (default)
5647@c @end table
5648
b37052ae
EZ
5649@node Tracepoints
5650@chapter Tracepoints
5651@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
5652@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
5653
5654@cindex tracepoints
5655In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
5656the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
5657anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
5658depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
5659might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
5660fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
5661to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
5662
5663Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
5664specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
5665arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
5666Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
5667those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
5668expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
5669for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
5670a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
5671in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
5672values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
5673unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
5674
5675The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
5676targets. @xref{Targets}.
5677
5678This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
5679
5680@menu
5681* Set Tracepoints::
5682* Analyze Collected Data::
5683* Tracepoint Variables::
5684@end menu
5685
5686@node Set Tracepoints
5687@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
5688
5689Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
5690tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
5691tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
5692breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
5693one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
5694tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
5695work on.
5696
5697For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
5698of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
5699it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
5700local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
5701commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
5702tracepoint was hit.
5703
5704This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
5705conditions and actions.
5706
5707@menu
5708* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
5709* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
5710* Tracepoint Passcounts::
5711* Tracepoint Actions::
5712* Listing Tracepoints::
5713* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
5714@end menu
5715
5716@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
5717@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
5718
5719@table @code
5720@cindex set tracepoint
5721@kindex trace
5722@item trace
5723The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
5724Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
5725the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
5726defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
5727debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
5728program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
5729doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
5730cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
5731running.
5732
5733Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
5734
5735@smallexample
5736(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
5737
5738(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
5739
5740(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
5741
5742(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
5743
5744(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
5745@end smallexample
5746
5747@noindent
5748You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
5749
5750@vindex $tpnum
5751@cindex last tracepoint number
5752@cindex recent tracepoint number
5753@cindex tracepoint number
5754The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
5755of the most recently set tracepoint.
5756
5757@kindex delete tracepoint
5758@cindex tracepoint deletion
5759@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5760Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
5761default is to delete all tracepoints.
5762
5763Examples:
5764
5765@smallexample
5766(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
5767
5768(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
5769@end smallexample
5770
5771@noindent
5772You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
5773@end table
5774
5775@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5776@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5777
5778@table @code
5779@kindex disable tracepoint
5780@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5781Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
5782@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
5783the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
5784a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
5785
5786@kindex enable tracepoint
5787@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5788Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
5789tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
5790run.
5791@end table
5792
5793@node Tracepoint Passcounts
5794@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
5795
5796@table @code
5797@kindex passcount
5798@cindex tracepoint pass count
5799@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
5800Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
5801automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
5802@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
5803the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
5804@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
5805passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
5806given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
5807user.
5808
5809Examples:
5810
5811@smallexample
5812(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of tracepoint 2
5813
5814(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
5815 // most recently defined tracepoint.
5816(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5817(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
5818(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
5819(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
5820(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
5821(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
5822 // executed 3 times OR when bar has
5823 // been executed 2 times
5824 // OR when baz has been executed 1 time.
5825@end smallexample
5826@end table
5827
5828@node Tracepoint Actions
5829@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
5830
5831@table @code
5832@kindex actions
5833@cindex tracepoint actions
5834@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5835This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
5836tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
5837specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
5838recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
5839@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
5840actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
5841terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
5842far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
5843@code{while-stepping}.
5844
5845@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
5846To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
5847and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
5848
5849@smallexample
5850(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
5851
5852(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times and collect data
5853
5854(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
5855@end smallexample
5856
5857In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
5858commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
5859hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
5860following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
5861followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
5862@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
5863@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
5864@code{end} command.
5865
5866@smallexample
5867(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5868(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
5869Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
5870> collect bar,baz
5871> collect $regs
5872> while-stepping 12
5873 > collect $fp, $sp
5874 > end
5875end
5876@end smallexample
5877
5878@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
5879@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
5880Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
5881This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
5882In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
5883special arguments are supported:
5884
5885@table @code
5886@item $regs
5887collect all registers
5888
5889@item $args
5890collect all function arguments
5891
5892@item $locals
5893collect all local variables.
5894@end table
5895
5896You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
5897with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
5898arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
5899
5900@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
5901@item while-stepping @var{n}
5902Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
5903new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
5904followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
5905its own @code{end} command):
5906
5907@smallexample
5908> while-stepping 12
5909 > collect $regs, myglobal
5910 > end
5911>
5912@end smallexample
5913
5914@noindent
5915You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
5916@code{stepping}.
5917@end table
5918
5919@node Listing Tracepoints
5920@subsection Listing Tracepoints
5921
5922@table @code
5923@kindex info tracepoints
5924@cindex information about tracepoints
5925@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5926Display information the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify a
5927tracepoint number displays information about all the tracepoints
5928defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
5929shown:
5930
5931@itemize @bullet
5932@item
5933its number
5934@item
5935whether it is enabled or disabled
5936@item
5937its address
5938@item
5939its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
5940@item
5941its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
5942@item
5943where in the source files is the tracepoint set
5944@item
5945its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
5946@end itemize
5947
5948@smallexample
5949(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
5950Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
59511 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
59522 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in gdb_test at gdb_test.c:375
59533 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in collect_data at ../foo.c:1741
5954(@value{GDBP})
5955@end smallexample
5956
5957@noindent
5958This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
5959@end table
5960
5961@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
5962@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
5963
5964@table @code
5965@kindex tstart
5966@cindex start a new trace experiment
5967@cindex collected data discarded
5968@item tstart
5969This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
5970begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
5971the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
5972experiment.
5973
5974@kindex tstop
5975@cindex stop a running trace experiment
5976@item tstop
5977This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
5978stops collecting data.
5979
5980@strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
5981automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
5982(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
5983
5984@kindex tstatus
5985@cindex status of trace data collection
5986@cindex trace experiment, status of
5987@item tstatus
5988This command displays the status of the current trace data
5989collection.
5990@end table
5991
5992Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
5993
5994@smallexample
5995(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
5996(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
5997Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
5998> collect $regs,$locals,$args
5999> while-stepping 11
6000 > collect $regs
6001 > end
6002> end
6003(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6004 [time passes @dots{}]
6005(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6006@end smallexample
6007
6008
6009@node Analyze Collected Data
6010@section Using the collected data
6011
6012After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6013for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6014collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6015snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6016consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6017examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6018specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6019snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6020registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6021rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6022debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6023(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6024behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6025when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6026the buffer will fail.
6027
6028@menu
6029* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6030* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6031* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6032@end menu
6033
6034@node tfind
6035@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6036
6037@kindex tfind
6038@cindex select trace snapshot
6039@cindex find trace snapshot
6040The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6041@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6042counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6043snapshot is selected.
6044
6045Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6046
6047@table @code
6048@item tfind start
6049Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6050@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6051
6052@item tfind none
6053Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6054
6055@item tfind end
6056Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6057
6058@item tfind
6059No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6060
6061@item tfind -
6062Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6063retracing earlier steps.
6064
6065@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6066Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6067proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6068argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6069for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6070
6071@item tfind pc @var{addr}
6072Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6073program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6074snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6075snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6076
6077@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6078Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6079addresses.
6080
6081@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6082Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6083@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6084
6085@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6086Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6087the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6088that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6089trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6090next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6091@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6092stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6093@end table
6094
6095The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6096designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6097instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6098snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6099trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6100simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6101snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6102@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6103The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6104for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6105no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6106(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6107no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6108tracepoint as the current one.
6109
6110In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6111these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6112scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6113you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6114registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6115
6116@smallexample
6117(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6118(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6119> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6120 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6121> tfind
6122> end
6123
6124Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6125Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6126Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6127Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6128Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6129Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6130Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6131Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6132Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6133Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6134Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6135@end smallexample
6136
6137Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6138the buffer:
6139
6140@smallexample
6141(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6142(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6143> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6144> tfind line
6145> end
6146
6147Frame 0, X = 1
6148Frame 7, X = 2
6149Frame 13, X = 255
6150@end smallexample
6151
6152@node tdump
6153@subsection @code{tdump}
6154@kindex tdump
6155@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6156@cindex tracepoint data, display
6157
6158This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6159the current trace snapshot.
6160
6161@smallexample
6162(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6163(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6164Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6165> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6166> end
6167
6168(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6169
6170(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6171#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6172at gdb_test.c:444
6173444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6174
6175(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6176Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6177d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6178d1 0x18 24
6179d2 0x80 128
6180d3 0x33 51
6181d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6182d5 0x22 34
6183d6 0xe0 224
6184d7 0x380035 3670069
6185a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6186a1 0x3000668 50333288
6187a2 0x100 256
6188a3 0x322000 3284992
6189a4 0x3000698 50333336
6190a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6191fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6192sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6193ps 0x0 0
6194pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6195fpcontrol 0x0 0
6196fpstatus 0x0 0
6197fpiaddr 0x0 0
6198p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6199p1 = (void *) 0x11
6200p2 = (void *) 0x22
6201p3 = (void *) 0x33
6202p4 = (void *) 0x44
6203p5 = (void *) 0x55
6204p6 = (void *) 0x66
6205gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6206
6207(@value{GDBP})
6208@end smallexample
6209
6210@node save-tracepoints
6211@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6212@kindex save-tracepoints
6213@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6214
6215This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6216their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6217suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6218tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6219Files}).
6220
6221@node Tracepoint Variables
6222@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6223@cindex tracepoint variables
6224@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6225
6226@table @code
6227@vindex $trace_frame
6228@item (int) $trace_frame
6229The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6230snapshot is selected.
6231
6232@vindex $tracepoint
6233@item (int) $tracepoint
6234The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6235
6236@vindex $trace_line
6237@item (int) $trace_line
6238The line number for the current trace snapshot.
6239
6240@vindex $trace_file
6241@item (char []) $trace_file
6242The source file for the current trace snapshot.
6243
6244@vindex $trace_func
6245@item (char []) $trace_func
6246The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
6247@end table
6248
6249Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
6250use @code{output} instead.
6251
6252Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
6253stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
6254data.
6255
6256@smallexample
6257(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6258
6259(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
6260> output $trace_file
6261> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
6262> tfind
6263> end
6264@end smallexample
6265
6d2ebf8b 6266@node Languages
c906108c
SS
6267@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
6268@cindex languages
6269
c906108c
SS
6270Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
6271rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
6272dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
6273Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 6274represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 6275@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
6276
6277@cindex working language
6278Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
6279allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
6280native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
6281consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
6282language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
6283language}.
6284
6285@menu
6286* Setting:: Switching between source languages
6287* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 6288* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
6289* Support:: Supported languages
6290@end menu
6291
6d2ebf8b 6292@node Setting
c906108c
SS
6293@section Switching between source languages
6294
6295There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
6296set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
6297@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
6298defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
6299used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
6300are printed, etc.
6301
6302In addition to the working language, every source file that
6303@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
6304file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
6305source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
6306language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
b37052ae 6307controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
c906108c 6308show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
6309set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
6310set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
6311Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
6312
6313This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 6314as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
6315another language. In that case, make the
6316program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
6317@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
6318program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
6319
6320@menu
6321* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
6322* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
6323* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6324@end menu
6325
6d2ebf8b 6326@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
6327@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
6328
6329If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
6330@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
6331
6332@table @file
6333
6334@item .c
6335C source file
6336
6337@item .C
6338@itemx .cc
6339@itemx .cp
6340@itemx .cpp
6341@itemx .cxx
6342@itemx .c++
b37052ae 6343C@t{++} source file
c906108c
SS
6344
6345@item .f
6346@itemx .F
6347Fortran source file
6348
c906108c
SS
6349@item .ch
6350@itemx .c186
6351@itemx .c286
96a2c332 6352CHILL source file
c906108c 6353
c906108c
SS
6354@item .mod
6355Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
6356
6357@item .s
6358@itemx .S
6359Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
6360@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
6361@end table
6362
6363In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
6364extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
6365
6d2ebf8b 6366@node Manually
c906108c
SS
6367@subsection Setting the working language
6368
6369If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
6370expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
6371your program.
6372
6373@kindex set language
6374If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
6375command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 6376a language, such as
c906108c 6377@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
6378For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
6379
c906108c
SS
6380Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
6381language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
6382to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
6383source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
6384languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
6385source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
6386command such as:
6387
6388@example
6389print a = b + c
6390@end example
6391
6392@noindent
6393might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
6394@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
6395printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
6396@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 6397
6d2ebf8b 6398@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
6399@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6400
6401To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
6402@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
6403then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
6404frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
6405working language to the language recorded for the function in that
6406frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
6407or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
6408does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
6409not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
6410
6411This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
6412entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
6413written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
6414a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
6415case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
6416
6d2ebf8b 6417@node Show
c906108c 6418@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
6419
6420The following commands help you find out which language is the
6421working language, and also what language source files were written in.
6422
6423@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
6424@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
6425@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
6426@table @code
6427@item show language
6428Display the current working language. This is the
6429language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
6430build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
6431
6432@item info frame
5d161b24 6433Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 6434working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 6435@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
6436information listed here.
6437
6438@item info source
6439Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 6440@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
6441information listed here.
6442@end table
6443
6444In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
6445not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
6446with a language explicitly:
6447
6448@kindex set extension-language
6449@kindex info extensions
6450@table @code
6451@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
6452Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
6453the source language @var{language}.
6454
6455@item info extensions
6456List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
6457@end table
6458
6d2ebf8b 6459@node Checks
c906108c
SS
6460@section Type and range checking
6461
6462@quotation
6463@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
6464checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
6465section documents the intended facilities.
6466@end quotation
6467@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
6468
6469Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
6470errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
6471checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
6472sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
6473these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
6474by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
6475errors when your program is running.
6476
6477@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
6478Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
6479can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
6480the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
6481@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
6482your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
6483for the default settings of supported languages.
6484
6485@menu
6486* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
6487* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
6488@end menu
6489
6490@cindex type checking
6491@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 6492@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
6493@subsection An overview of type checking
6494
6495Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
6496arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
6497otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
6498errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
6499
6500@smallexample
65011 + 2 @result{} 3
6502@exdent but
6503@error{} 1 + 2.3
6504@end smallexample
6505
6506The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
6507type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
6508
5d161b24
DB
6509For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
6510@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
6511to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
6512or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
6513but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
6514these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
6515also issues a warning.
6516
5d161b24
DB
6517Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
6518related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
6519For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
6520a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
6521with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
6522the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
6523
6524Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
6525instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
6526operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
6527represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
6528operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
6529details on specific languages.
6530
6531@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
6532
d4f3574e 6533@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
6534@kindex set check type
6535@kindex show check type
6536@table @code
6537@item set check type auto
6538Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
6539@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
6540each language.
6541
6542@item set check type on
6543@itemx set check type off
6544Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
6545current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
6546match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 6547evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
6548message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
6549
6550@item set check type warn
6551Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
6552evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
6553be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
6554numbers and structures.
6555
6556@item show type
5d161b24 6557Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
6558is setting it automatically.
6559@end table
6560
6561@cindex range checking
6562@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 6563@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
6564@subsection An overview of range checking
6565
6566In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
6567bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
6568checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
6569computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
6570not exceed the bounds of the array.
6571
6572For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
6573@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
6574always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
6575warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
6576
6577A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
6578array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
6579of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
6580error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
6581result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
6582the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
6583
6584@example
6585@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
6586@end example
6587
6588This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
6589specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
6590Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
6591
6592@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
6593
d4f3574e 6594@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
6595@kindex set check range
6596@kindex show check range
6597@table @code
6598@item set check range auto
6599Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
6600@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
6601each language.
6602
6603@item set check range on
6604@itemx set check range off
6605Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
6606current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
6607match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
6608then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
6609
6610@item set check range warn
6611Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
6612but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
6613expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
6614memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
6615systems).
6616
6617@item show range
6618Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
6619being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
6620@end table
c906108c 6621
6d2ebf8b 6622@node Support
c906108c 6623@section Supported languages
c906108c 6624
b37052ae 6625@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
cce74817 6626@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
6627Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
6628language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
6629and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
6630,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
6631language.
6632
6633The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
6634supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
6635tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
6636@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
6637formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
6638books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
6639language reference or tutorial.
6640
c906108c 6641@menu
b37052ae 6642* C:: C and C@t{++}
cce74817 6643* Modula-2:: Modula-2
104c1213 6644* Chill:: Chill
c906108c
SS
6645@end menu
6646
6d2ebf8b 6647@node C
b37052ae 6648@subsection C and C@t{++}
7a292a7a 6649
b37052ae
EZ
6650@cindex C and C@t{++}
6651@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
c906108c 6652
b37052ae 6653Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
c906108c
SS
6654to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
6655together.
6656
41afff9a
EZ
6657@cindex C@t{++}
6658@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
b37052ae
EZ
6659@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
6660The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
6661compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
6662effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
6663C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6664compiler (@code{aCC}).
6665
b37052ae 6666For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the stabs debugging
c906108c
SS
6667format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
6668command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
6669@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
6670CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 6671
c906108c 6672@menu
b37052ae
EZ
6673* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
6674* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
6675* C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
6676* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
6677* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
c906108c 6678* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
b37052ae 6679* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 6680@end menu
c906108c 6681
6d2ebf8b 6682@node C Operators
b37052ae 6683@subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7a292a7a 6684
b37052ae 6685@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
c906108c
SS
6686
6687Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
6688@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 6689often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 6690
b37052ae 6691For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
6692
6693@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 6694
c906108c 6695@item
c906108c 6696@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
b37052ae 6697specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
6698
6699@item
d4f3574e
SS
6700@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
6701@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
6702
6703@item
53a5351d 6704@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
6705
6706@item
6707@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 6708
c906108c
SS
6709@end itemize
6710
6711@noindent
6712The following operators are supported. They are listed here
6713in order of increasing precedence:
6714
6715@table @code
6716@item ,
6717The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
6718are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
6719expression being the last expression evaluated.
6720
6721@item =
6722Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
6723assigned. Defined on scalar types.
6724
6725@item @var{op}=
6726Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
6727and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 6728@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
6729@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
6730@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
6731
6732@item ?:
6733The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
6734of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
6735integral type.
6736
6737@item ||
6738Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6739
6740@item &&
6741Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
6742
6743@item |
6744Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6745
6746@item ^
6747Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6748
6749@item &
6750Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
6751
6752@item ==@r{, }!=
6753Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
6754expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
6755
6756@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
6757Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
6758Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
6759and non-zero for true.
6760
6761@item <<@r{, }>>
6762left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
6763
6764@item @@
6765The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6766
6767@item +@r{, }-
6768Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
6769pointer types.
6770
6771@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
6772Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
6773defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
6774integral types.
6775
6776@item ++@r{, }--
6777Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
6778operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
6779when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
6780operation takes place.
6781
6782@item *
6783Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
6784@code{++}.
6785
6786@item &
6787Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
6788
b37052ae
EZ
6789For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
6790allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
c906108c 6791(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
b37052ae 6792where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
c906108c 6793stored.
c906108c
SS
6794
6795@item -
6796Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
6797precedence as @code{++}.
6798
6799@item !
6800Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6801@code{++}.
6802
6803@item ~
6804Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6805@code{++}.
6806
6807
6808@item .@r{, }->
6809Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
6810@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
6811pointer based on the stored type information.
6812Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
6813
c906108c
SS
6814@item .*@r{, }->*
6815Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
6816
6817@item []
6818Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
6819@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6820
6821@item ()
6822Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6823
c906108c 6824@item ::
b37052ae 6825C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7a292a7a 6826and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
6827
6828@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
6829Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
6830(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
6831above.
c906108c
SS
6832@end table
6833
c906108c
SS
6834If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
6835attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
6836predefined meaning.
c906108c 6837
c906108c 6838@menu
5d161b24 6839* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
6840@end menu
6841
6d2ebf8b 6842@node C Constants
b37052ae 6843@subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 6844
b37052ae 6845@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 6846
b37052ae 6847@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
c906108c 6848following ways:
c906108c
SS
6849
6850@itemize @bullet
6851@item
6852Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6853specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
6854a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
6855@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
6856@code{long} value.
6857
6858@item
6859Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
6860point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
6861exponent. An exponent is of the form:
6862@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
6863sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
6864A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
6865@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
6866the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
6867a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
6868constant.
c906108c
SS
6869
6870@item
6871Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
6872integral equivalents.
6873
6874@item
6875Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
6876(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 6877(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
6878be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
6879the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
6880of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
6881@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
6882@samp{\n} for newline.
6883
6884@item
96a2c332
SS
6885String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
6886double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
6887above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
6888a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
6889characters.
c906108c
SS
6890
6891@item
6892Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
6893to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
6894
6895@item
6896Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
6897and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
6898integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
6899and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
6900@end itemize
6901
c906108c 6902@menu
5d161b24
DB
6903* C plus plus expressions::
6904* C Defaults::
6905* C Checks::
c906108c 6906
5d161b24 6907* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
6908@end menu
6909
6d2ebf8b 6910@node C plus plus expressions
b37052ae
EZ
6911@subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
6912
6913@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
6914@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
6915
6916@cindex C@t{++} support, not in @sc{coff}
6917@cindex @sc{coff} versus C@t{++}
6918@cindex C@t{++} and object formats
6919@cindex object formats and C@t{++}
6920@cindex a.out and C@t{++}
6921@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C@t{++}
6922@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C@t{++}
6923@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C@t{++}
6924@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6925@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
6926@c periodically whether this has happened...
6927@quotation
b37052ae
EZ
6928@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
6929proper compiler. Typically, C@t{++} debugging depends on the use of
c906108c
SS
6930additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
6931special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
6932@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
6933symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
6934you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
6935extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
b37052ae 6936@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6937support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
6938@end quotation
c906108c
SS
6939
6940@enumerate
6941
6942@cindex member functions
6943@item
6944Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
6945
6946@example
6947count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
6948@end example
6949
41afff9a 6950@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
b37052ae 6951@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6952@item
6953While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
6954expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
6955that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
b37052ae 6956pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
c906108c 6957
c906108c 6958@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 6959@cindex overloaded functions, calling
b37052ae 6960@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6961@item
6962You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 6963call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
6964perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
6965calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
6966in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
6967default arguments.
6968
6969It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
6970promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
6971class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
6972functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
6973number of function arguments.
6974
6975Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
6976@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
b37052ae 6977,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c 6978
d4f3574e 6979You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
6980explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
6981@smallexample
6982p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
6983@end smallexample
d4f3574e 6984
c906108c 6985The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 6986see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 6987
c906108c
SS
6988@cindex reference declarations
6989@item
b37052ae
EZ
6990@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
6991them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
c906108c
SS
6992dereferenced.
6993
6994In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
6995reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
6996avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
6997The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
6998you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
6999
7000@item
b37052ae 7001@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
c906108c
SS
7002expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
7003one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
7004necessary, for example in an expression like
7005@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
b37052ae 7006resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7007debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
7008@end enumerate
7009
b37052ae 7010In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
53a5351d
JM
7011calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
7012objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
7013invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 7014
6d2ebf8b 7015@node C Defaults
b37052ae 7016@subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7a292a7a 7017
b37052ae 7018@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
c906108c 7019
c906108c
SS
7020If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
7021both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
b37052ae 7022C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c 7023selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
7024
7025If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
7026recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
7027@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
b37052ae 7028these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
c906108c
SS
7029@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
7030for further details.
7031
c906108c
SS
7032@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
7033@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
7034@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 7035
6d2ebf8b 7036@node C Checks
b37052ae 7037@subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7a292a7a 7038
b37052ae 7039@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
c906108c 7040
b37052ae 7041By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
c906108c
SS
7042is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
7043considers two variables type equivalent if:
7044
7045@itemize @bullet
7046@item
7047The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
7048enumerated tag.
7049
7050@item
7051The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
7052declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
7053
7054@ignore
7055@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
7056@c FIXME--beers?
7057@item
7058The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
7059declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
7060compilers.)
7061@end ignore
7062@end itemize
7063
7064Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
7065indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
7066that is not itself an array.
c906108c 7067
6d2ebf8b 7068@node Debugging C
c906108c 7069@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
7070
7071The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
7072the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
7073inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
7074appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
7075
7076The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
7077with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
7078,Expressions}.
7079
c906108c 7080@menu
5d161b24 7081* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
7082@end menu
7083
6d2ebf8b 7084@node Debugging C plus plus
b37052ae 7085@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7086
b37052ae 7087@cindex commands for C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7088
b37052ae
EZ
7089Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
7090designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
c906108c
SS
7091
7092@table @code
7093@cindex break in overloaded functions
7094@item @r{breakpoint menus}
7095When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
7096@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
7097you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
7098
b37052ae 7099@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7100@item rbreak @var{regex}
7101Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
7102breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
7103classes.
7104@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
7105
b37052ae 7106@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
7107@item catch throw
7108@itemx catch catch
b37052ae 7109Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
c906108c
SS
7110Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
7111
7112@cindex inheritance
7113@item ptype @var{typename}
7114Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
7115@var{typename}.
7116@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
7117
b37052ae 7118@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
c906108c
SS
7119@item set print demangle
7120@itemx show print demangle
7121@itemx set print asm-demangle
7122@itemx show print asm-demangle
b37052ae
EZ
7123Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
7124displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
c906108c
SS
7125@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7126
7127@item set print object
7128@itemx show print object
7129Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
7130@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7131
7132@item set print vtbl
7133@itemx show print vtbl
7134Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
7135@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c 7136(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 7137ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
7138
7139@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 7140@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c 7141@item set overload-resolution on
b37052ae 7142Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
c906108c
SS
7143is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
7144and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
b37052ae 7145using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
d4f3574e 7146expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
7147message.
7148
7149@item set overload-resolution off
b37052ae 7150Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
c906108c
SS
7151overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7152chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
7153symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
7154overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7155searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
7156argument types.
c906108c
SS
7157
7158@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
7159You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
b37052ae 7160the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
c906108c
SS
7161@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
7162also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
7163available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
7164@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
7165@end table
c906108c 7166
6d2ebf8b 7167@node Modula-2
c906108c 7168@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 7169
d4f3574e 7170@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
7171
7172The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
7173output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
7174developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
7175attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
7176to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
7177table.
7178
7179@cindex expressions in Modula-2
7180@menu
7181* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
7182* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
7183* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
7184* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
7185* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
7186* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
7187* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7188* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
7189@end menu
7190
6d2ebf8b 7191@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
7192@subsubsection Operators
7193@cindex Modula-2 operators
7194
7195Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7196@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
7197often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
7198following definitions hold:
7199
7200@itemize @bullet
7201
7202@item
7203@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
7204their subranges.
7205
7206@item
7207@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
7208
7209@item
7210@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
7211
7212@item
7213@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
7214@var{type}}.
7215
7216@item
7217@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
7218
7219@item
7220@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
7221
7222@item
7223@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
7224@end itemize
7225
7226@noindent
7227The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
7228increasing precedence:
7229
7230@table @code
7231@item ,
7232Function argument or array index separator.
7233
7234@item :=
7235Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
7236@var{value}.
7237
7238@item <@r{, }>
7239Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
7240types.
7241
7242@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 7243Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
7244on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
7245set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
7246
7247@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
7248Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
7249Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
7250available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
7251comment character.
7252
7253@item IN
7254Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
7255Same precedence as @code{<}.
7256
7257@item OR
7258Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
7259
7260@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 7261Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
7262
7263@item @@
7264The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7265
7266@item +@r{, }-
7267Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
7268and difference on set types.
7269
7270@item *
7271Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
7272on set types.
7273
7274@item /
7275Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
7276types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
7277
7278@item DIV@r{, }MOD
7279Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
7280precedence as @code{*}.
7281
7282@item -
7283Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
7284
7285@item ^
7286Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
7287
7288@item NOT
7289Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
7290@code{^}.
7291
7292@item .
7293@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
7294precedence as @code{^}.
7295
7296@item []
7297Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
7298
7299@item ()
7300Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
7301as @code{^}.
7302
7303@item ::@r{, }.
7304@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
7305@end table
7306
7307@quotation
7308@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
7309treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
7310@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
7311@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
7312@end quotation
7313
7314@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
6d2ebf8b 7315@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c
SS
7316@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
7317
7318Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
7319In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
7320
7321@table @var
7322
7323@item a
7324represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
7325
7326@item c
7327represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
7328
7329@item i
7330represents a variable or constant of integral type.
7331
7332@item m
7333represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
7334same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
7335be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
7336
7337@item n
7338represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
7339
7340@item r
7341represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
7342
7343@item t
7344represents a type.
7345
7346@item v
7347represents a variable.
7348
7349@item x
7350represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
7351explanation of the function for details.
7352@end table
7353
7354All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
7355
7356@table @code
7357@item ABS(@var{n})
7358Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
7359
7360@item CAP(@var{c})
7361If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 7362equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
7363
7364@item CHR(@var{i})
7365Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7366
7367@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 7368Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
7369
7370@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
7371Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7372new value.
7373
7374@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7375Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
7376set.
7377
7378@item FLOAT(@var{i})
7379Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
7380
7381@item HIGH(@var{a})
7382Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
7383
7384@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 7385Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
7386
7387@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
7388Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7389new value.
7390
7391@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7392Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
7393there. Returns the new set.
7394
7395@item MAX(@var{t})
7396Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
7397
7398@item MIN(@var{t})
7399Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
7400
7401@item ODD(@var{i})
7402Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
7403
7404@item ORD(@var{x})
7405Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
7406value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
7407@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
7408integral, character and enumerated types.
7409
7410@item SIZE(@var{x})
7411Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
7412
7413@item TRUNC(@var{r})
7414Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
7415
7416@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
7417Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7418@end table
7419
7420@quotation
7421@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
7422@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
7423an error.
7424@end quotation
7425
7426@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 7427@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
7428@subsubsection Constants
7429
7430@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
7431ways:
7432
7433@itemize @bullet
7434
7435@item
7436Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
7437expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
7438rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
7439trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
7440
7441@item
7442Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
7443decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
7444then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
7445@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
7446digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
7447digits.
7448
7449@item
7450Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
7451like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 7452also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
7453followed by a @samp{C}.
7454
7455@item
7456String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
7457pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
7458Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
b37052ae 7459Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
c906108c
SS
7460sequences.
7461
7462@item
7463Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
7464
7465@item
7466Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
7467@code{FALSE}.
7468
7469@item
7470Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
7471
7472@item
7473Set constants are not yet supported.
7474@end itemize
7475
6d2ebf8b 7476@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
7477@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
7478@cindex Modula-2 defaults
7479
7480If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7481both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 7482Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7483selected the working language.
7484
7485If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7486code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 7487working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
7488the language automatically}, for further details.
7489
6d2ebf8b 7490@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
7491@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
7492@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
7493
7494A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
7495This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
7496
7497@itemize @bullet
7498@item
7499Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
7500integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
7501debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
7502pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
7503through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
7504returned a pointer.)
7505
7506@item
7507C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
7508non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
7509escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
7510printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
7511
7512@item
7513The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
7514argument.
7515
7516@item
7517All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
7518@end itemize
7519
6d2ebf8b 7520@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
7521@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
7522@cindex Modula-2 checks
7523
7524@quotation
7525@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
7526range checking.
7527@end quotation
7528@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
7529
7530@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
7531
7532@itemize @bullet
7533@item
7534They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
7535@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
7536
7537@item
7538They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
7539@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
7540@end itemize
7541
7542As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
7543whose types are not equivalent is an error.
7544
7545Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
7546index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
7547
6d2ebf8b 7548@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
7549@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7550@cindex scope
41afff9a 7551@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
7552@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
7553@ifinfo
41afff9a 7554@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
7555@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
7556@end ifinfo
7557@iftex
41afff9a 7558@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
7559@end iftex
7560
7561There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
7562(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
7563similar syntax:
7564
7565@example
7566
7567@var{module} . @var{id}
7568@var{scope} :: @var{id}
7569@end example
7570
7571@noindent
7572where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
7573@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
7574identifier within your program, except another module.
7575
7576Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
7577specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
7578found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
7579enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
7580
7581Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
7582the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
7583definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
7584an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
7585module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
7586@var{module}.
7587
6d2ebf8b 7588@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
7589@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
7590
7591Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
7592Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
b37052ae 7593specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
c906108c 7594@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
b37052ae 7595apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
c906108c
SS
7596analogue in Modula-2.
7597
7598The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 7599with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c 7600intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
b37052ae 7601created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
c906108c 7602address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 7603@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
7604
7605@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
7606In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
7607interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 7608
6d2ebf8b 7609@node Chill
cce74817
JM
7610@subsection Chill
7611
7612The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
d4f3574e 7613from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
cce74817
JM
7614supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
7615likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
7616table.
7617
d4f3574e
SS
7618@c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
7619@c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
7620This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
cce74817
JM
7621of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
7622
7623@menu
104c1213
JM
7624* How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
7625* Locations:: Locations and their accesses
cce74817 7626* Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
5d161b24 7627* Chill type and range checks::
53a5351d 7628* Chill defaults::
cce74817
JM
7629@end menu
7630
6d2ebf8b 7631@node How modes are displayed
cce74817
JM
7632@subsubsection How modes are displayed
7633
7634The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
d4f3574e 7635with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
cce74817
JM
7636slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
7637provided modes are:
d4f3574e
SS
7638
7639@c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
7640@c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
cce74817
JM
7641@table @code
7642@item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
7643@itemize @bullet
7644@item
7645@emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
7646UINT, LONG, ULONG},
7647@item
5d161b24 7648@emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
cce74817 7649@item
5d161b24 7650@emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
cce74817
JM
7651@item
7652@emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
7653@smallexample
7654(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7655type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
7656@end smallexample
7657If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
7658@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7659@emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
7660@smallexample
7661@code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
7662@end smallexample
7663where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
7664expression (e.g. set element names).
cce74817
JM
7665@end itemize
7666
7667@item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
7668A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
d4f3574e 7669the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
cce74817
JM
7670@smallexample
7671(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7672type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
7673@end smallexample
7674
7675@item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
7676@itemize @bullet
7677@item
d4f3574e 7678@emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
cce74817
JM
7679followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
7680@item
7681@emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
7682@end itemize
7683
7684@item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
7685The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
7686<return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
d4f3574e
SS
7687list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
7688the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
cce74817
JM
7689all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
7690
7691@ignore
7692@item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
7693The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
5d161b24 7694type, and is therefore not really of interest.
cce74817
JM
7695@end ignore
7696
5d161b24 7697@item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
7698@itemize @bullet
7699@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7700@emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
7701@smallexample
7702@code{EVENT (<event length>)}
7703@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
7704where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
7705@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7706@emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
7707@smallexample
7708@code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
7709@end smallexample
7710where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
cce74817
JM
7711@end itemize
7712
5d161b24 7713@item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
7714@itemize @bullet
7715@item
7716@emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
7717@item
7718@emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
7719@end itemize
7720
7721@item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
7722Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
7723
7724@item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
7725@itemize @bullet
7726@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7727@emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
7728@smallexample
7729@code{CHARS(<string length>)}
7730@end smallexample
7731followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
7732mode
cce74817 7733@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7734@emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
7735@smallexample
7736@code{BOOLS(<string
7737length>)}
7738@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
7739@end itemize
7740
7741@item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
7742The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
7743followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
7744@smallexample
7745(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
5d161b24
DB
7746type = ARRAY (1:42)
7747 ARRAY (1:20)
cce74817
JM
7748 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
7749@end smallexample
7750
5d161b24 7751@item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
cce74817 7752The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
d4f3574e
SS
7753list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
7754of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
7755OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
cce74817
JM
7756of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
7757checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
7758always displays all variant fields.
7759@smallexample
7760(@value{GDBP}) ptype str
7761type = STRUCT (
7762 as x,
7763 bs x,
7764 CASE bs OF
7765 (karli):
7766 cs a
7767 (ott):
7768 ds x
7769 ESAC
7770)
7771@end smallexample
7772@end table
7773
6d2ebf8b 7774@node Locations
cce74817
JM
7775@subsubsection Locations and their accesses
7776
7777A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
7778
7779A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
d4f3574e
SS
7780the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
7781Chill programs. How values are specified
7782is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
7783
7784The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
7785display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
d4f3574e 7786
cce74817
JM
7787@smallexample
7788set result := EXPR
7789@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
7790
7791@noindent
7792This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
c3f6f71d 7793is not available in @value{GDBN}).
cce74817
JM
7794
7795Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
7796value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
d4f3574e 7797mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
cce74817
JM
7798represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
7799value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
d4f3574e 7800operator @samp{->}.
cce74817 7801
6d2ebf8b
SS
7802Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
7803@smallexample
7804@code{@{ PROC
cce74817 7805(<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
6d2ebf8b
SS
7806location>}
7807@end smallexample
7808@code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
7809specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
7810the entry point.
cce74817
JM
7811
7812@ignore
7813Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
7814fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
7815the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
d4f3574e
SS
7816implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
7817na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
7818<instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
cce74817
JM
7819@code{__proc_copy}.
7820
7821Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
7822the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
7823like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
7824mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
7825
7826Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
d4f3574e 7827...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
cce74817 7828definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
d4f3574e
SS
7829of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
7830structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
7831braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
cce74817 7832on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
d4f3574e 7833memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
cce74817 7834all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
d4f3574e 7835@code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
cce74817
JM
7836stuff ???)
7837@smallexample
7838(@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
7839[.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
7840@end smallexample
7841@end ignore
7842
7843Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
7844(e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
d4f3574e
SS
7845certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
7846and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
7847
7848A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
d4f3574e
SS
7849location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
7850name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
7851have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
7852checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
cce74817 7853therefore the result can be quite confusing.
d4f3574e 7854
cce74817
JM
7855@smallexample
7856(@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
7857@end smallexample
7858
6d2ebf8b 7859@node Values and their Operations
cce74817
JM
7860@subsubsection Values and their Operations
7861
7862Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
7863more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
d4f3574e
SS
7864data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
7865such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
cce74817 7866constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
d4f3574e 7867when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
cce74817
JM
7868(e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
7869the values behind these locations.
7870
d4f3574e 7871This section describes how values have to be specified and which
cce74817
JM
7872operations are legal to be used with such values.
7873
7874@table @code
7875@item Literal Values
d4f3574e
SS
7876Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
7877For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
cce74817 7878chapter 1.5.
d4f3574e
SS
7879@c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
7880@c be converted to a @ref.
cce74817 7881
5d161b24 7882@ignore
cce74817
JM
7883@itemize @bullet
7884@item
7885@emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
d4f3574e 7886programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
cce74817
JM
7887@item
7888@emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
7889@item
7890@emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
7891@code{'M'})
7892@item
7893@emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
d4f3574e 7894mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
b37052ae 7895comparable to an enumeration in C/C@t{++} language.
cce74817 7896@item
d4f3574e 7897@emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
cce74817 7898emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
5d161b24 7899procedure value or the empty instance value.
cce74817
JM
7900
7901@item
7902@emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
d4f3574e 7903enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
cce74817
JM
7904to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
7905@item
7906@emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
7907programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
7908@item
7909@emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
d4f3574e 7910(gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
cce74817
JM
7911@end itemize
7912@end ignore
7913
7914@item Tuple Values
7915A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
d4f3574e 7916name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
cce74817
JM
7917unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
7918@code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
d4f3574e 7919
cce74817
JM
7920@itemize @bullet
7921@item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
7922@item @emph{Array Tuple}
7923@item @emph{Structure Tuple}
7924Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
d4f3574e 7925same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
cce74817
JM
7926@end itemize
7927
7928@item String Element Value
6d2ebf8b
SS
7929A string element value is specified by
7930@smallexample
7931@code{<string value>(<index>)}
7932@end smallexample
d4f3574e 7933where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
cce74817
JM
7934value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
7935the string.
7936
7937@item String Slice Value
7938A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
7939spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
7940expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
7941@code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
7942The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
7943string.
7944
7945@item Array Element Values
7946An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
7947delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
7948
7949@item Array Slice Values
7950An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
7951@code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
d4f3574e
SS
7952@code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
7953arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
cce74817
JM
7954which is part of the specified array.
7955
7956@item Structure Field Values
7957A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
d4f3574e
SS
7958name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
7959in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
cce74817
JM
7960corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
7961
7962@item Procedure Call Value
7963The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
7964procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
7965expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
d4f3574e 7966effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
cce74817 7967
d4f3574e 7968Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
cce74817 7969
6d2ebf8b
SS
7970Values of time mode locations appear as
7971@smallexample
7972@code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
7973@end smallexample
7974
cce74817
JM
7975
7976@ignore
7977This is not implemented yet:
7978@item Built-in Value
7979@noindent
7980The following built in functions are provided:
d4f3574e 7981
cce74817
JM
7982@table @code
7983@item @code{ADDR()}
7984@item @code{NUM()}
7985@item @code{PRED()}
7986@item @code{SUCC()}
7987@item @code{ABS()}
7988@item @code{CARD()}
7989@item @code{MAX()}
7990@item @code{MIN()}
7991@item @code{SIZE()}
7992@item @code{UPPER()}
7993@item @code{LOWER()}
7994@item @code{LENGTH()}
7995@item @code{SIN()}
7996@item @code{COS()}
7997@item @code{TAN()}
7998@item @code{ARCSIN()}
7999@item @code{ARCCOS()}
8000@item @code{ARCTAN()}
8001@item @code{EXP()}
8002@item @code{LN()}
8003@item @code{LOG()}
8004@item @code{SQRT()}
8005@end table
8006
8007For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
8008chapter 1.6.
8009@end ignore
8010
8011@item Zero-adic Operator Value
8012The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
8013current active process.
8014
8015@item Expression Values
8016The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
d4f3574e 8017the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
cce74817 8018incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
d4f3574e 8019corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
cce74817 8020causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
d4f3574e 8021which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
cce74817 8022operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
d4f3574e 8023
cce74817
JM
8024@table @code
8025@item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
8026@itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
8027@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 8028Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
d4f3574e 8029
cce74817
JM
8030@item @code{=, /=}
8031Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
d4f3574e 8032
cce74817 8033@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 8034@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 8035Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 8036
cce74817 8037@item @code{+, -}
d4f3574e 8038@itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
cce74817 8039Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 8040
cce74817
JM
8041@item @code{-}
8042Change sign operator.
d4f3574e 8043
cce74817
JM
8044@item @code{//}
8045String concatenation operator.
d4f3574e 8046
cce74817
JM
8047@item @code{()}
8048String repetition operator.
d4f3574e 8049
cce74817
JM
8050@item @code{->}
8051Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
8052address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
8053location (@code{loc->}).
d4f3574e 8054
cce74817 8055@item @code{OR, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
8056@itemx @code{AND}
8057@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 8058Powerset and bitstring operators.
d4f3574e 8059
cce74817 8060@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 8061@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 8062Powerset inclusion operators.
d4f3574e 8063
cce74817
JM
8064@item @code{IN}
8065Membership operator.
8066@end table
8067@end table
8068
6d2ebf8b 8069@node Chill type and range checks
cce74817
JM
8070@subsubsection Chill type and range checks
8071
8072@value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
d4f3574e 8073of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
cce74817 8074complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
d4f3574e 8075equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
cce74817
JM
8076structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
8077
8078Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8079index bounds and all built in procedures.
8080
8081Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
d4f3574e 8082check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
cce74817
JM
8083operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
8084functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
8085language specification.
8086
cce74817
JM
8087All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
8088off}.
8089
5d161b24 8090@ignore
53a5351d 8091@c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
cce74817
JM
8092see last paragraph ?
8093@end ignore
8094
6d2ebf8b 8095@node Chill defaults
cce74817
JM
8096@subsubsection Chill defaults
8097
8098If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8099both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 8100Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
cce74817
JM
8101selected the working language.
8102
8103If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8104code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
d4f3574e 8105working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
cce74817
JM
8106the language automatically}, for further details.
8107
6d2ebf8b 8108@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
8109@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8110
d4f3574e 8111The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
8112symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8113program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8114does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8115program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8116(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8117file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8118
8119@cindex symbol names
8120@cindex names of symbols
8121@cindex quoting names
8122Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8123characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8124most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8125source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8126are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8127ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8128@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8129@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8130
8131@example
8132p 'foo.c'::x
8133@end example
8134
8135@noindent
8136looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8137
8138@table @code
8139@kindex info address
b37052ae 8140@cindex address of a symbol
c906108c
SS
8141@item info address @var{symbol}
8142Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8143variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8144local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8145is always stored.
8146
8147Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8148at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8149the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8150
3d67e040 8151@kindex info symbol
b37052ae 8152@cindex symbol from address
3d67e040
EZ
8153@item info symbol @var{addr}
8154Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8155If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8156nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8157
8158@example
8159(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8160_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
8161@end example
8162
8163@noindent
8164This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8165it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8166
c906108c 8167@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
8168@item whatis @var{expr}
8169Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
8170actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8171assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8172@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8173
8174@item whatis
8175Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8176
8177@kindex ptype
8178@item ptype @var{typename}
8179Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
8180the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8181@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8182@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 8183
d4f3574e 8184@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 8185@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 8186Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
8187differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8188of just the name of the type.
8189
8190For example, for this variable declaration:
8191
8192@example
8193struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
8194@end example
8195
8196@noindent
8197the two commands give this output:
8198
8199@example
8200@group
8201(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8202type = struct complex
8203(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8204type = struct complex @{
8205 double real;
8206 double imag;
8207@}
8208@end group
8209@end example
8210
8211@noindent
8212As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8213the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8214
8215@kindex info types
8216@item info types @var{regexp}
8217@itemx info types
d4f3574e 8218Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
8219(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
8220complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8221@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 8222names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
8223information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8224
8225This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8226@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
8227lists all source files where a type is defined.
8228
b37052ae
EZ
8229@kindex info scope
8230@cindex local variables
8231@item info scope @var{addr}
8232List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
8233accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
8234preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
8235scope defined by that location. For example:
8236
8237@smallexample
8238(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
8239Scope for command_line_handler:
8240Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
8241Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
8242Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
8243Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
8244Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
8245Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
8246Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
8247@end smallexample
8248
c906108c
SS
8249@kindex info source
8250@item info source
8251Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
8252the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
8253it was written in.
8254
8255@kindex info sources
8256@item info sources
8257Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
8258debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
8259have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
8260
8261@kindex info functions
8262@item info functions
8263Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
8264
8265@item info functions @var{regexp}
8266Print the names and data types of all defined functions
8267whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
8268Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
8269include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
8270start with @code{step}.
8271
8272@kindex info variables
8273@item info variables
8274Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
8275outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
8276
8277@item info variables @var{regexp}
8278Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
8279variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
8280@var{regexp}.
8281
8282@ignore
8283This was never implemented.
8284@kindex info methods
8285@item info methods
8286@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
8287The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
b37052ae
EZ
8288methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
8289specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
8290C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
c906108c
SS
8291from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
8292@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
8293which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
8294@end ignore
8295
c906108c
SS
8296@cindex reloading symbols
8297Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
8298be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
8299in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
8300running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
8301@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
8302
8303@table @code
8304@kindex set symbol-reloading
8305@item set symbol-reloading on
8306Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
8307object file with a particular name is seen again.
8308
8309@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
8310Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
8311same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
8312running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
8313should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
8314may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
8315several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
8316name.
c906108c
SS
8317
8318@kindex show symbol-reloading
8319@item show symbol-reloading
8320Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
8321@end table
c906108c 8322
c906108c
SS
8323@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
8324@item set opaque-type-resolution on
8325Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
8326declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
8327@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
8328source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
8329another source file. The default is on.
8330
8331A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
8332the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
8333
8334@item set opaque-type-resolution off
8335Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
8336is printed as follows:
8337@smallexample
8338@{<no data fields>@}
8339@end smallexample
8340
8341@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
8342@item show opaque-type-resolution
8343Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
8344
8345@kindex maint print symbols
8346@cindex symbol dump
8347@kindex maint print psymbols
8348@cindex partial symbol dump
8349@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
8350@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
8351@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
8352Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
8353These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
8354symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
8355symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
8356collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
8357only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
8358command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
8359use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
8360symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
8361files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
8362@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
8363required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
8364@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
8365@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
8366@end table
8367
6d2ebf8b 8368@node Altering
c906108c
SS
8369@chapter Altering Execution
8370
8371Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
8372find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
8373correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
8374experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
8375program.
8376
8377For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
8378locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
8379address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
8380
8381@menu
8382* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
8383* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 8384* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
8385* Returning:: Returning from a function
8386* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
8387* Patching:: Patching your program
8388@end menu
8389
6d2ebf8b 8390@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
8391@section Assignment to variables
8392
8393@cindex assignment
8394@cindex setting variables
8395To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
8396@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
8397
8398@example
8399print x=4
8400@end example
8401
8402@noindent
8403stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 8404value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
8405@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
8406information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
8407
8408@kindex set variable
8409@cindex variables, setting
8410If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
8411@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
8412really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
8413not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
8414,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
8415
c906108c
SS
8416If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
8417appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
8418variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
8419to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
8420program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
8421a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
8422command @code{set width}:
8423
8424@example
8425(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
8426type = double
8427(@value{GDBP}) p width
8428$4 = 13
8429(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
8430Invalid syntax in expression.
8431@end example
8432
8433@noindent
8434The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
8435order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
8436
8437@example
8438(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
8439@end example
53a5351d 8440
c906108c
SS
8441Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
8442with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
8443@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
8444your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
8445to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
8446the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
8447
8448@example
8449@group
8450(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
8451type = double
8452(@value{GDBP}) p g
8453$1 = 1
8454(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 8455(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
8456$2 = 1
8457(@value{GDBP}) r
8458The program being debugged has been started already.
8459Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
8460Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
8461"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
8462 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
8463(@value{GDBP}) show g
8464The current BFD target is "=4".
8465@end group
8466@end example
8467
8468@noindent
8469The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
8470@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
8471@code{g}, use
8472
8473@example
8474(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
8475@end example
c906108c
SS
8476
8477@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
8478freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
8479and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
8480same length or shorter.
8481@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
8482@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
8483
8484To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
8485construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
8486(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
8487to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
8488and representation in memory), and
8489
8490@example
8491set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
8492@end example
8493
8494@noindent
8495stores the value 4 into that memory location.
8496
6d2ebf8b 8497@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
8498@section Continuing at a different address
8499
8500Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
8501it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
8502an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
8503
8504@table @code
8505@kindex jump
8506@item jump @var{linespec}
8507Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
8508immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
8509source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
8510@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
8511in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
8512breakpoints}.
8513
8514The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
8515the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
8516register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
8517a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
8518be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
8519of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
8520confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
8521executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
8522well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
8523
8524@item jump *@var{address}
8525Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
8526@end table
8527
c906108c 8528@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
8529On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
8530command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
8531difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
8532changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
8533example,
c906108c
SS
8534
8535@example
8536set $pc = 0x485
8537@end example
8538
8539@noindent
8540makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
8541address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
8542@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
8543
8544The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
8545up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
8546that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
8547detail.
8548
c906108c 8549@c @group
6d2ebf8b 8550@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
8551@section Giving your program a signal
8552
8553@table @code
8554@kindex signal
8555@item signal @var{signal}
8556Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
8557signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
8558signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
8559SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
8560
8561Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
8562giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
8563a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
8564@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
8565signal.
8566
8567@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
8568after executing the command.
8569@end table
8570@c @end group
8571
8572Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
8573@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
8574causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
8575the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
8576passes the signal directly to your program.
8577
c906108c 8578
6d2ebf8b 8579@node Returning
c906108c
SS
8580@section Returning from a function
8581
8582@table @code
8583@cindex returning from a function
8584@kindex return
8585@item return
8586@itemx return @var{expression}
8587You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
8588command. If you give an
8589@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
8590value.
8591@end table
8592
8593When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
8594(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
8595discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
8596be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
8597
8598This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
8599frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
8600innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
8601specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
8602of functions.
8603
8604The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
8605program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
8606returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
8607and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
8608selected stack frame returns naturally.
8609
6d2ebf8b 8610@node Calling
c906108c
SS
8611@section Calling program functions
8612
8613@cindex calling functions
8614@kindex call
8615@table @code
8616@item call @var{expr}
8617Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
8618returned values.
8619@end table
8620
8621You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
8622execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
8623with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
8624is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 8625
c906108c
SS
8626For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
8627specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
8628calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
8629method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
8630that have separate instruction and data spaces.
c906108c 8631
6d2ebf8b 8632@node Patching
c906108c 8633@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 8634
c906108c
SS
8635@cindex patching binaries
8636@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 8637@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 8638
7a292a7a
SS
8639By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
8640executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
8641alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
8642patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
8643
8644If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
8645explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
8646want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
8647repairs.
8648
8649@table @code
8650@kindex set write
8651@item set write on
8652@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
8653If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
8654core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
8655off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
8656
8657If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
8658@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
8659write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
8660
8661@item show write
8662@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
8663Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
8664as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
8665@end table
8666
6d2ebf8b 8667@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
8668@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
8669
7a292a7a
SS
8670@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
8671both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
8672program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
8673@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
8674
8675@menu
8676* Files:: Commands to specify files
8677* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
8678@end menu
8679
6d2ebf8b 8680@node Files
c906108c 8681@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 8682
7a292a7a 8683@cindex symbol table
c906108c 8684@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
8685
8686You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
8687way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
8688@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
8689Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
8690
8691Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
8692@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
8693a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
8694to specify new files are useful.
8695
8696@table @code
8697@cindex executable file
8698@kindex file
8699@item file @var{filename}
8700Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
8701symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
8702executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
8703directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
8704@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
8705directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
8706to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
8707and your program, using the @code{path} command.
8708
6d2ebf8b 8709On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
8710@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
8711@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
8712@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
8713descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
8714(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 8715@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 8716for more information.
c906108c
SS
8717
8718@item file
8719@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
8720has on both executable file and the symbol table.
8721
8722@kindex exec-file
8723@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8724Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
8725in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
8726if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
8727discard information on the executable file.
8728
8729@kindex symbol-file
8730@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8731Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
8732searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
8733table and program to run from the same file.
8734
8735@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
8736program's symbol table.
8737
5d161b24 8738The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
8739of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
8740auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
8741the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
8742the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
8743
8744@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
8745executing it once.
8746
8747When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
8748understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
8749generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
8750other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
8751Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
8752using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
8753optimized code.
c906108c
SS
8754
8755For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
8756using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
8757symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
8758quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
8759details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
8760
8761The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
8762start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
8763occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
8764file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
8765pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
8766warnings and messages}.)
8767
c906108c
SS
8768We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
8769symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
8770symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
8771still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
8772in stabs format.
8773
8774@kindex readnow
8775@cindex reading symbols immediately
8776@cindex symbols, reading immediately
8777@kindex mapped
8778@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
8779@cindex saving symbol table
8780@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8781@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8782You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
8783tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
8784load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 8785entire symbol table available.
c906108c 8786
c906108c
SS
8787If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
8788@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
8789cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
8790file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
8791from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
8792than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
8793program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
8794starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
8795
8796You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
8797file has all the symbol information for your program.
8798
8799The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
8800@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
8801than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
8802it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
8803needed.
8804
8805The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
8806@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
8807symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
8808
8809@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
8810@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
8811@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
8812@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
8813@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
8814@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
8815@c files.
8816
8817@kindex core
8818@kindex core-file
8819@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8820Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
8821of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
8822address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
8823executable file itself for other parts.
8824
8825@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
8826to be used.
8827
8828Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
8829under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
8830wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
8831the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 8832(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 8833
c906108c
SS
8834@kindex add-symbol-file
8835@cindex dynamic linking
8836@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
8837@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
d167840f 8838@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}
96a2c332
SS
8839The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
8840information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
8841when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
8842into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
8843address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
8844this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
8845of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
8846section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
8847@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
8848
8849The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
8850originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
8851@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
8852thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
8853instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c
SS
8854
8855@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8856
8857You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
8858the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
8859table information for @var{filename}.
8860
8861@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
8862@item add-shared-symbol-file
8863The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
8864operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
8865shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 8866@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 8867
c906108c
SS
8868@kindex section
8869@item section
5d161b24
DB
8870The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
8871the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
8872section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
8873specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
8874separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
8875the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
8876
8877@kindex info files
8878@kindex info target
8879@item info files
8880@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
8881@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
8882current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
8883including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
8884use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
8885command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
8886current ones.
8887
c906108c
SS
8888@end table
8889
8890All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
8891as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
8892name and remembers it that way.
8893
c906108c 8894@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
8895@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
8896libraries.
53a5351d 8897
c906108c
SS
8898@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
8899when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
8900(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
8901references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
8902debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
8903
8904On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
8905automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
8906
c906108c
SS
8907@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
8908@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
8909@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
8910
8911@table @code
8912@kindex info sharedlibrary
8913@kindex info share
8914@item info share
8915@itemx info sharedlibrary
8916Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
8917
8918@kindex sharedlibrary
8919@kindex share
8920@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
8921@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
8922Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
8923Unix regular expression.
8924As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
8925required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
8926@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
8927loaded.
8928@end table
8929
53a5351d
JM
8930On HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} detects the loading of a shared library
8931and automatically reads in symbols from the newly loaded library, up to
8932a threshold that is initially set but that you can modify if you wish.
c906108c
SS
8933
8934Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
8935loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
8936@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
8937automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
8938
8939To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
8940
8941@table @code
8942@kindex set auto-solib-add
8943@item set auto-solib-add @var{threshold}
8944Set the autoloading size threshold, in megabytes. If @var{threshold} is
8945nonzero, symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded
8946automatically when the inferior begins execution or when the dynamic
8947linker informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded, until
8948the symbol table of the program and libraries exceeds this threshold.
8949Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
8950@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 megabytes.
8951
8952@kindex show auto-solib-add
8953@item show auto-solib-add
8954Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
8955@end table
c906108c 8956
6d2ebf8b 8957@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
8958@section Errors reading symbol files
8959
8960While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
8961such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
8962output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
8963they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
8964debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
8965about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
8966only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
8967times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
8968to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
8969complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8970messages}).
8971
8972The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
8973
8974@table @code
8975@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
8976
8977The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
8978(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
8979error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
8980in its outer scope blocks.
8981
8982@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
8983the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
8984may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
8985function.
8986
8987@item block at @var{address} out of order
8988
8989The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
8990order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
8991do so.
8992
8993@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
8994locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
8995can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
8996@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8997messages}.)
8998
8999@item bad block start address patched
9000
9001The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
9002smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
9003to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
9004
9005@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
9006starting on the previous source line.
9007
9008@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
9009
9010@cindex foo
9011Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
9012larger than the size of the string table.
9013
9014@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
9015name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
9016with this name.
9017
9018@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
9019
7a292a7a
SS
9020The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
9021not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 9022uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 9023
7a292a7a
SS
9024@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
9025This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 9026are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
9027debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
9028on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
9029and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
9030
9031@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 9032
7a292a7a 9033@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 9034
7a292a7a 9035@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
b37052ae 9036The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
9037information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
9038it.
c906108c
SS
9039
9040@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
9041
9042@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 9043
c906108c
SS
9044@end table
9045
6d2ebf8b 9046@node Targets
c906108c 9047@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 9048
c906108c
SS
9049@cindex debugging target
9050@kindex target
9051
9052A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
9053
9054Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
9055in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
9056you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
9057flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
9058host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
9059realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
9060command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
9061(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
9062
9063@menu
9064* Active Targets:: Active targets
9065* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
9066* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
9067* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 9068* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
9069
9070@end menu
9071
6d2ebf8b 9072@node Active Targets
c906108c 9073@section Active targets
7a292a7a 9074
c906108c
SS
9075@cindex stacking targets
9076@cindex active targets
9077@cindex multiple targets
9078
c906108c 9079There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
9080executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
9081active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
9082start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
9083a core file.
c906108c
SS
9084
9085For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
9086@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
9087well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
9088@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
9089first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
9090requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
9091are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
9092read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
9093executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
9094
9095When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
9096target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
9097commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
9098an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
9099process target is active.
c906108c 9100
7a292a7a
SS
9101Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
9102core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 9103files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
9104the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
9105process}).
c906108c 9106
6d2ebf8b 9107@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
9108@section Commands for managing targets
9109
9110@table @code
9111@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
9112Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
9113process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
9114facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
9115protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
9116
9117Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
9118typically include things like device names or host names to connect
9119with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
9120
9121The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
9122after executing the command.
9123
9124@kindex help target
9125@item help target
9126Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
9127currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
9128(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
9129
9130@item help target @var{name}
9131Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
9132select it.
9133
9134@kindex set gnutarget
9135@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 9136@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 9137knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
9138a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
9139with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
9140with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
9141
d4f3574e 9142@quotation
c906108c
SS
9143@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
9144you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 9145@end quotation
c906108c 9146
d4f3574e
SS
9147@noindent
9148@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 9149
5d161b24 9150@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
9151@item show gnutarget
9152Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
9153@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
9154@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
9155and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
9156@end table
9157
c906108c
SS
9158Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
9159configuration):
c906108c
SS
9160
9161@table @code
9162@kindex target exec
9163@item target exec @var{program}
9164An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
9165@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
9166
c906108c
SS
9167@kindex target core
9168@item target core @var{filename}
9169A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
9170@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
9171
9172@kindex target remote
9173@item target remote @var{dev}
9174Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
9175specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
9176@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 9177supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
9178some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
9179it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
9180
c906108c
SS
9181@kindex target sim
9182@item target sim
2df3850c 9183Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213
JM
9184In general,
9185@example
9186 target sim
9187 load
9188 run
9189@end example
d4f3574e 9190@noindent
104c1213 9191works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 9192drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
9193provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
9194see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
9195Processors}.
9196
c906108c
SS
9197@end table
9198
104c1213 9199Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
9200
9201@table @code
9202
c906108c
SS
9203@kindex target nrom
9204@item target nrom @var{dev}
9205NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
9206
c906108c
SS
9207@end table
9208
5d161b24 9209Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 9210your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
9211
9212Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
9213once you've successfully established a connection.
9214
9215@table @code
9216
9217@kindex load @var{filename}
9218@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
9219Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
9220@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
9221is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
9222on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
9223@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
9224the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9225
9226If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
9227execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
9228target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
9229
9230The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
9231For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
9232link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
9233specifies a fixed address.
9234@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
9235
c906108c
SS
9236@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9237@end table
9238
6d2ebf8b 9239@node Byte Order
c906108c 9240@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 9241
c906108c
SS
9242@cindex choosing target byte order
9243@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
9244
9245Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
9246offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
9247orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
9248designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
9249which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 9250@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
9251
9252@table @code
9253@kindex set endian big
9254@item set endian big
9255Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
9256
9257@kindex set endian little
9258@item set endian little
9259Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
9260
9261@kindex set endian auto
9262@item set endian auto
9263Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
9264executable.
9265
9266@item show endian
9267Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
9268
9269@end table
9270
9271Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
9272data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
9273target system.
9274
6d2ebf8b 9275@node Remote
c906108c
SS
9276@section Remote debugging
9277@cindex remote debugging
9278
9279If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
9280@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
9281For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
9282or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
9283powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
9284
9285Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
9286to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 9287@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
9288but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
9289write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
9290communicate with @value{GDBN}.
9291
9292Other remote targets may be available in your
9293configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 9294
c906108c 9295@menu
c906108c 9296* Remote Serial:: @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
c906108c
SS
9297@end menu
9298
6d2ebf8b 9299@node Remote Serial
104c1213 9300@subsection The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
7a292a7a 9301
104c1213
JM
9302@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
9303To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
9304@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
9305prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
9306program, you need:
c906108c 9307
104c1213
JM
9308@enumerate
9309@item
9310A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
9311have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
9312your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 9313
5d161b24 9314@item
d4f3574e 9315A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 9316subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 9317
104c1213
JM
9318@item
9319A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
9320download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
9321manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
9322documentation.
9323@end enumerate
96baa820 9324
104c1213
JM
9325The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
9326communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
9327machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 9328
104c1213
JM
9329@table @emph
9330@item On the host,
9331@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
9332else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
9333(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
9334
9335@item On the target,
9336you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
9337implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
9338subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
9339
9340On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
9341@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
9342@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
9343@end table
96baa820 9344
104c1213
JM
9345The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
9346machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
9347@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 9348
104c1213
JM
9349@cindex remote serial stub list
9350These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 9351
104c1213
JM
9352@table @code
9353
9354@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 9355@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9356@cindex Intel
9357@cindex i386
9358For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
9359
9360@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 9361@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9362@cindex Motorola 680x0
9363@cindex m680x0
9364For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
9365
9366@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 9367@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9368@cindex Hitachi
9369@cindex SH
9370For Hitachi SH architectures.
9371
9372@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 9373@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9374@cindex Sparc
9375For @sc{sparc} architectures.
9376
9377@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 9378@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9379@cindex Fujitsu
9380@cindex SparcLite
9381For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
9382
9383@end table
9384
9385The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
9386recently added stubs.
9387
9388@menu
9389* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
9390* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
9391* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
9392* Protocol:: Definition of the communication protocol
9393* Server:: Using the `gdbserver' program
9394* NetWare:: Using the `gdbserve.nlm' program
9395@end menu
9396
6d2ebf8b 9397@node Stub Contents
104c1213
JM
9398@subsubsection What the stub can do for you
9399
9400@cindex remote serial stub
9401The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
9402subroutines:
9403
9404@table @code
9405@item set_debug_traps
9406@kindex set_debug_traps
9407@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
9408This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
9409program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
9410beginning of your program.
9411
9412@item handle_exception
9413@kindex handle_exception
9414@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
9415This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
9416explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
9417run when a trap is triggered.
9418
9419@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
9420execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
9421with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
9422protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 9423representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
9424information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
9425retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
9426execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
9427@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 9428machine.
104c1213
JM
9429
9430@item breakpoint
9431@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
9432Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
9433breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
9434way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
9435machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
9436pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
9437@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
9438simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
9439again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
9440your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 9441@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
9442
9443Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
9444to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
9445start of your debugging session.
9446@end table
9447
6d2ebf8b 9448@node Bootstrapping
104c1213
JM
9449@subsubsection What you must do for the stub
9450
9451@cindex remote stub, support routines
9452The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
9453chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
9454debugging target machine.
9455
9456First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
9457serial port.
9458
9459@table @code
9460@item int getDebugChar()
9461@kindex getDebugChar
9462Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
9463It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
9464different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
9465
9466@item void putDebugChar(int)
9467@kindex putDebugChar
9468Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 9469It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
9470different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
9471@end table
9472
9473@cindex control C, and remote debugging
9474@cindex interrupting remote targets
9475If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
9476running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
9477for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
9478character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
9479remote system to stop.
9480
9481Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
9482probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
9483is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
9484@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
9485
9486Other routines you need to supply are:
9487
9488@table @code
9489@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
9490@kindex exceptionHandler
9491Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
9492handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
9493way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
9494are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
9495containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
9496@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
9497its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
9498might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
9499exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
9500@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
9501and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
9502you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
9503should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
9504
9505For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
9506gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
9507should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
9508@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
9509help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
9510
9511@item void flush_i_cache()
9512@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 9513On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
9514instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
9515instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
9516
9517On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
9518function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
9519@end table
9520
9521@noindent
9522You must also make sure this library routine is available:
9523
9524@table @code
9525@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
9526@kindex memset
9527This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
9528memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
9529@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
9530either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
9531@end table
9532
9533If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
9534library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
9535but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 9536subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
9537
9538
6d2ebf8b 9539@node Debug Session
104c1213
JM
9540@subsubsection Putting it all together
9541
9542@cindex remote serial debugging summary
9543In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
9544steps.
9545
9546@enumerate
9547@item
6d2ebf8b 9548Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
9549(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
9550@display
9551@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
9552@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
9553@end display
9554
9555@item
9556Insert these lines near the top of your program:
9557
9558@example
9559set_debug_traps();
9560breakpoint();
9561@end example
9562
9563@item
9564For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
9565@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
9566
9567@example
9568void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
9569@end example
9570
d4f3574e 9571@noindent
104c1213 9572but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 9573function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
9574@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
9575error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
9576one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
9577
9578@item
9579Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
9580your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
9581
9582@item
9583Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
9584the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
9585
9586@item
9587@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
9588@c document that. FIXME.
9589Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
9590whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
9591
9592@item
9593To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
9594as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
9595This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
9596of its pure text.
9597
d4f3574e 9598@item
104c1213 9599@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 9600Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
9601Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
9602machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
9603TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
9604to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
9605device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
9606
9607@example
9608target remote /dev/ttyb
9609@end example
9610
9611@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
9612To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
9613@code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
9614terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
9615
9616@example
9617target remote manyfarms:2828
9618@end example
9619@end enumerate
9620
9621Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
9622step and continue the remote program.
9623
9624To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
9625command.
9626
9627@cindex interrupting remote programs
9628@cindex remote programs, interrupting
9629Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
9630interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
9631program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
9632and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
9633interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
9634
9635@example
9636Interrupted while waiting for the program.
9637Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
9638@end example
9639
9640If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
9641(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
9642remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
9643goes back to waiting.
9644
6d2ebf8b 9645@node Protocol
104c1213
JM
9646@subsubsection Communication protocol
9647
9648@cindex debugging stub, example
9649@cindex remote stub, example
9650@cindex stub example, remote debugging
9651The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
9652communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
9653@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
9654these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
9655implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
9656with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
9657organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
9658
9659However, there may be occasions when you need to know something about
9660the protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your
9661target machine, you might want your program to do something special if
9662it recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
9663
9664In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
9665transmitted and received data respectfully.
9666
9667@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
9668@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
9669@cindex remote serial protocol
6cf7e474
AC
9670All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
9671sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
9672@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
9673@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
104c1213
JM
9674
9675@example
9676@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9677@end example
9678@noindent
104c1213
JM
9679
9680@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
9681@noindent
9682The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
6cf7e474
AC
9683characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
9684eight bit unsigned checksum).
9685
9686Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
9687specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
9688
9689@example
9690@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9691@end example
104c1213
JM
9692
9693@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
9694@noindent
6cf7e474
AC
9695That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
9696has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
9697since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
104c1213 9698
6cf7e474 9699@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
104c1213
JM
9700When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
9701response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
9702the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
9703retransmission):
9704
9705@example
9706<- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9707-> @code{+}
9708@end example
9709@noindent
104c1213
JM
9710
9711The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
9712debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
9713the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
9714when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
9715
9716@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
6cf7e474
AC
9717exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
9718exceptions).
9719
9720Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
9721@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
9722HEX with leading zeros suppressed.
9723
9724Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
9725@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
9726would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
104c1213
JM
9727
9728Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
c3f6f71d 9729means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
104c1213
JM
9730which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
9731@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
d4f3574e
SS
9732where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
9733characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
9734value greater than 126 should not be used.
9735
9736Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
9737loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
9738character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
104c1213
JM
9739
9740So:
9741@example
9742"@code{0* }"
9743@end example
9744@noindent
9745means the same as "0000".
9746
598ca718 9747The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
104c1213
JM
9748error number. That number is not well defined.
9749
9750For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
9751(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
9752protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
d4f3574e 9753on that response.
104c1213 9754
f1251bdd
C
9755A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
9756@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
9757optional.
9758
104c1213
JM
9759Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
9760their corresponding response @var{data}:
598ca718 9761@page
104c1213
JM
9762@multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
9763@item Packet
9764@tab Request
9765@tab Description
9766
f1251bdd 9767@item extended ops
104c1213
JM
9768@tab @code{!}
9769@tab
d4f3574e 9770Use the extended remote protocol. Sticky---only needs to be set once.
598ca718 9771The extended remote protocol supports the @samp{R} packet.
104c1213
JM
9772@item
9773@tab reply @samp{}
9774@tab
9775Stubs that support the extended remote protocol return @samp{} which,
9776unfortunately, is identical to the response returned by stubs that do not
9777support protocol extensions.
9778
9779@item last signal
9780@tab @code{?}
9781@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9782Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
9783and continue.
9784@item
9785@tab reply
9786@tab see below
9787
104c1213
JM
9788
9789@item reserved
9790@tab @code{a}
5d161b24 9791@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9792
f1251bdd 9793@item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
104c1213
JM
9794@tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
9795@tab
598ca718
EZ
9796@item
9797@tab
9798@tab
104c1213
JM
9799Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
9800specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
d4f3574e 9801See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
104c1213
JM
9802@item
9803@tab reply @code{OK}
9804@item
9805@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9806
9807@item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
9808@tab @code{b}@var{baud}
9809@tab
9810Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
9811transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
9812transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
9813acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
9814to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
9815ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
9816specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
9817that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
9818happened.}
9819
9820@item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
9821@tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
9822@tab
9823Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
9824breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
9825@samp{z} packets.}
9826
9827@item continue
9828@tab @code{c}@var{addr}
9829@tab
9830@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9831current address.
9832@item
9833@tab reply
9834@tab see below
9835
f1251bdd 9836@item continue with signal
104c1213
JM
9837@tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9838@tab
9839Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
9840@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
9841@item
9842@tab reply
9843@tab see below
9844
598ca718 9845@item toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
104c1213
JM
9846@tab @code{d}
9847@tab
d4f3574e 9848toggle debug flag.
104c1213 9849
f1251bdd 9850@item detach
104c1213 9851@tab @code{D}
d4f3574e 9852@tab
2df3850c
JM
9853Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
9854@value{GDBN} disconnects.
d4f3574e
SS
9855@item
9856@tab reply @emph{no response}
9857@tab
598ca718 9858@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
104c1213
JM
9859
9860@item reserved
9861@tab @code{e}
5d161b24 9862@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9863
9864@item reserved
9865@tab @code{E}
5d161b24 9866@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9867
9868@item reserved
9869@tab @code{f}
5d161b24 9870@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9871
9872@item reserved
9873@tab @code{F}
5d161b24 9874@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9875
9876@item read registers
9877@tab @code{g}
9878@tab Read general registers.
9879@item
9880@tab reply @var{XX...}
9881@tab
9882Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
9883with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
d4f3574e 9884each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
2df3850c 9885determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
d4f3574e
SS
9886@var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
9887@code{g} packets is specified below.
104c1213
JM
9888@item
9889@tab @code{E}@var{NN}
9890@tab for an error.
9891
9892@item write regs
9893@tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
9894@tab
9895See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
9896@item
9897@tab reply @code{OK}
9898@tab for success
9899@item
9900@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9901@tab for an error
9902
9903@item reserved
9904@tab @code{h}
5d161b24 9905@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9906
f1251bdd 9907@item set thread
104c1213
JM
9908@tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
9909@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9910Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
9911@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
9912continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
9913thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
104c1213
JM
9914@item
9915@tab reply @code{OK}
9916@tab for success
9917@item
9918@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9919@tab for an error
9920
d4f3574e
SS
9921@c FIXME: JTC:
9922@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
5d161b24 9923@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
d4f3574e
SS
9924@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
9925@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
9926@c described. For example:
9927@c
9928@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9929@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
9930@c otherwise returns current registers.
9931@c
9932@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9933@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
9934@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
9935
f1251bdd 9936@item cycle step @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
9937@tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
9938@tab
9939Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
9940present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
9941step starting at that address.
9942
f1251bdd 9943@item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
104c1213
JM
9944@tab @code{I}
9945@tab
9946See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
9947
9948@item reserved
9949@tab @code{j}
9950@tab Reserved for future use
9951
9952@item reserved
9953@tab @code{J}
5d161b24 9954@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9955
f1251bdd 9956@item kill request
104c1213
JM
9957@tab @code{k}
9958@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9959FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how operate when a specific
9960thread context has been selected (ie. does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
104c1213
JM
9961
9962@item reserved
9963@tab @code{l}
5d161b24 9964@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9965
9966@item reserved
9967@tab @code{L}
5d161b24 9968@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9969
9970@item read memory
9971@tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9972@tab
9973Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
2df3850c 9974Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
d4f3574e
SS
9975using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
9976transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
9977@item
9978@tab reply @var{XX...}
9979@tab
d4f3574e 9980@var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
2df3850c 9981to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
d4f3574e
SS
9982sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
9983@emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
9984@item
9985@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9986@tab @var{NN} is errno
9987
9988@item write mem
9989@tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
9990@tab
9991Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
9992@var{XX...} is the data.
9993@item
9994@tab reply @code{OK}
9995@tab for success
9996@item
9997@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9998@tab
9999for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
10000written).
10001
10002@item reserved
10003@tab @code{n}
5d161b24 10004@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10005
10006@item reserved
10007@tab @code{N}
5d161b24 10008@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10009
10010@item reserved
10011@tab @code{o}
5d161b24 10012@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10013
10014@item reserved
10015@tab @code{O}
5d161b24 10016@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10017
10018@item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
10019@tab @code{p}@var{n...}
10020@tab
10021See write register.
10022@item
10023@tab return @var{r....}
10024@tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
10025
f1251bdd 10026@item write reg
104c1213
JM
10027@tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
10028@tab
10029Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
10030digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
10031@item
10032@tab reply @code{OK}
10033@tab for success
10034@item
10035@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10036@tab for an error
10037
f1251bdd 10038@item general query
104c1213
JM
10039@tab @code{q}@var{query}
10040@tab
598ca718 10041Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries
104c1213 10042have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
d4f3574e
SS
10043company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
10044optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
10045must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
104c1213
JM
10046@item
10047@tab reply @code{XX...}
d4f3574e 10048@tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
104c1213
JM
10049@item
10050@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10051@tab error reply
10052@item
10053@tab reply @samp{}
10054@tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
10055
f1251bdd 10056@item general set
104c1213
JM
10057@tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
10058@tab
10059Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
10060naming conventions.
10061
598ca718 10062@item reset @strong{(deprecated)}
d4f3574e
SS
10063@tab @code{r}
10064@tab
10065Reset the entire system.
104c1213 10066
f1251bdd 10067@item remote restart
104c1213
JM
10068@tab @code{R}@var{XX}
10069@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10070Restart the remote server. @var{XX} while needed has no clear
10071definition. FIXME: @emph{An example interaction explaining how this
10072packet is used in extended-remote mode is needed}.
104c1213 10073
f1251bdd 10074@item step
104c1213
JM
10075@tab @code{s}@var{addr}
10076@tab
10077@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
10078same address.
10079@item
10080@tab reply
10081@tab see below
10082
f1251bdd 10083@item step with signal
104c1213
JM
10084@tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
10085@tab
10086Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
10087@item
10088@tab reply
10089@tab see below
10090
f1251bdd 10091@item search
104c1213
JM
10092@tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
10093@tab
10094Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
10095@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
d4f3574e 10096bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
104c1213 10097
f1251bdd 10098@item thread alive
104c1213
JM
10099@tab @code{T}@var{XX}
10100@tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
10101@item
10102@tab reply @code{OK}
10103@tab thread is still alive
10104@item
10105@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10106@tab thread is dead
5d161b24 10107
104c1213
JM
10108@item reserved
10109@tab @code{u}
5d161b24 10110@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10111
10112@item reserved
10113@tab @code{U}
5d161b24 10114@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10115
10116@item reserved
10117@tab @code{v}
5d161b24 10118@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10119
10120@item reserved
10121@tab @code{V}
5d161b24 10122@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10123
10124@item reserved
10125@tab @code{w}
5d161b24 10126@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10127
10128@item reserved
10129@tab @code{W}
5d161b24 10130@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10131
10132@item reserved
10133@tab @code{x}
5d161b24 10134@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 10135
f1251bdd 10136@item write mem (binary)
104c1213
JM
10137@tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
10138@tab
10139@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
d4f3574e
SS
10140binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
10141escaped using @code{0x7d}.
104c1213
JM
10142@item
10143@tab reply @code{OK}
10144@tab for success
10145@item
10146@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10147@tab for an error
10148
10149@item reserved
10150@tab @code{y}
5d161b24 10151@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10152
10153@item reserved
10154@tab @code{Y}
5d161b24 10155@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 10156
f1251bdd 10157@item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
10158@tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10159@tab
10160See @samp{Z}.
10161
f1251bdd 10162@item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
10163@tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10164@tab
10165@var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
10166breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
10167@samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
10168bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
10169the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
d4f3574e
SS
10170@var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
10171potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
6d2ebf8b 10172implemented in an idempotent way.
104c1213
JM
10173@item
10174@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10175@tab for an error
10176@item
10177@tab reply @code{OK}
10178@tab for success
10179@item
10180@tab @samp{}
10181@tab If not supported.
10182
10183@item reserved
10184@tab <other>
5d161b24 10185@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10186
10187@end multitable
10188
d4f3574e
SS
10189The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
10190receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
10191@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
10192when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
10193number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
10194conventions is used.
104c1213
JM
10195
10196@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
10197
10198@item @code{S}@var{AA}
10199@tab @var{AA} is the signal number
10200
10201@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
10202@tab
10203@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
10204(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
10205by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
10206thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
d4f3574e 10207starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
104c1213
JM
10208@var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
10209extend the protocol.
10210
10211@item @code{W}@var{AA}
10212@tab
10213The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
10214applicable for certains sorts of targets.
10215
10216@item @code{X}@var{AA}
10217@tab
10218The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
10219
6d2ebf8b 10220@item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{t...}@code{;}@var{d...}@code{;}@var{b...} @strong{(obsolete)}
104c1213 10221@tab
6d2ebf8b
SS
10222@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t...} = address of symbol "_start";
10223@var{d...} = base of data section; @var{b...} = base of bss section.
10224@emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference between
10225this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may arrive
10226spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the host
10227debugger.}
104c1213
JM
10228
10229@item @code{O}@var{XX...}
10230@tab
c3f6f71d 10231@var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at any time
104c1213
JM
10232while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
10233for 'W', 'T', etc.
10234
10235@end multitable
10236
d4f3574e
SS
10237The following set and query packets have already been defined.
10238
10239@multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
10240
10241@item current thread
10242@tab @code{q}@code{C}
10243@tab Return the current thread id.
10244@item
10245@tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
10246@tab
10247Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
10248@item
10249@tab reply *
10250@tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
10251
bba2971c
MS
10252@item all thread ids
10253@tab @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
10254@item
10255@tab @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
d4f3574e 10256@tab
bba2971c
MS
10257Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
10258may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
10259works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
10260obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
5d161b24 10261be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
bba2971c 10262sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
d4f3574e 10263@item
bba2971c
MS
10264@tab
10265@tab NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
d4f3574e 10266@item
5d161b24 10267@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>}
bba2971c
MS
10268@tab A single thread id
10269@item
00e4a2e4 10270@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>},@var{<id>...}
bba2971c
MS
10271@tab a comma-separated list of thread ids
10272@item
10273@tab reply @code{l}
10274@tab (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
10275@item
10276@tab
10277@tab
10278In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one
10279or more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. GDB will
10280respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
10281@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
10282(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
10283
10284@item extra thread info
480ff1fb 10285@tab @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id}
bba2971c
MS
10286@tab
10287@item
10288@tab
10289@tab
10290Where @var{<id>} is a thread-id in big-endian hex.
10291Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
10292the target OS. This string may contain anything that the target OS
10293thinks is interesting for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.
10294The string is displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display.
5d161b24 10295Some examples of possible thread extra info strings are "Runnable", or
bba2971c
MS
10296"Blocked on Mutex".
10297@item
10298@tab reply @var{XX...}
10299@tab
10300Where @var{XX...} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising the
10301printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
10302attributes.
d4f3574e
SS
10303
10304@item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
10305@tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
10306@tab
2b628194
MS
10307@item
10308@tab
10309@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10310Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
10311digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
10312subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
10313number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
10314(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
10315returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
10316@item
bba2971c
MS
10317@tab
10318@tab NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
10319query (see above).
10320@item
d4f3574e
SS
10321@tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
10322@tab
2b628194
MS
10323@item
10324@tab
10325@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10326Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
10327returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
10328and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
10329digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
10330a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
10331digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
10332
bba2971c
MS
10333@item compute CRC of memory block
10334@tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10335@tab
10336@item
10337@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10338@tab An error (such as memory fault)
10339@item
10340@tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
10341@tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
10342
d4f3574e
SS
10343@item query sect offs
10344@tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
917317f4
JM
10345@tab
10346Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
10347image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
10348response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
10349offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
d4f3574e
SS
10350@item
10351@tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
10352
10353@item thread info request
10354@tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
10355@tab
598ca718
EZ
10356@item
10357@tab
10358@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10359Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
10360encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
10361@item
10362@tab reply *
10363@tab
10364See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
10365
10366@item remote command
10367@tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
10368@tab
598ca718
EZ
10369@item
10370@tab
10371@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10372@var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
10373execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
10374Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
10375number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
10376packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
10377stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
10378@item
10379@tab reply @code{OK}
10380@tab
10381A command response with no output.
10382@item
10383@tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
10384@tab
10385A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
10386@item
10387@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10388@tab
10389Indicate a badly formed request.
10390
10391@item
10392@tab reply @samp{}
10393@tab
10394When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
10395
10396@end multitable
10397
10398The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
10399In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
10400bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
10401space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
10402The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
10403least-significant.
10404
10405@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
10406
10407@item MIPS32
10408@tab
10409All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
1041032 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
10411registers; fsr; fir; fp.
10412
10413@item MIPS64
10414@tab
10415All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
10416thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
10417as @code{MIPS32}.
10418
10419@end multitable
10420
104c1213
JM
10421Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
10422does not get any direct output:
10423
10424@example
10425<- @code{R00}
10426-> @code{+}
10427@emph{target restarts}
10428<- @code{?}
10429-> @code{+}
10430-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
10431<- @code{+}
10432@end example
10433
10434Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
10435
10436@example
10437<- @code{G1445...}
10438-> @code{+}
10439<- @code{s}
10440-> @code{+}
10441@emph{time passes}
10442-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
10443<- @code{+}
10444<- @code{g}
10445-> @code{+}
10446-> @code{1455...}
10447<- @code{+}
10448@end example
10449
6d2ebf8b 10450@node Server
104c1213
JM
10451@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10452
10453@kindex gdbserver
10454@cindex remote connection without stubs
10455@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10456allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10457@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10458
10459@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10460because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10461that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10462@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10463@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10464because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10465also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10466started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10467Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10468the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10469do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10470by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10471choice for debugging.
10472
10473@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10474or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10475protocol.
10476
10477@table @emph
10478@item On the target machine,
10479you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10480@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10481strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10482system does all the symbol handling.
10483
10484To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
10485the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The
10486syntax is:
10487
10488@smallexample
10489target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10490@end smallexample
10491
10492@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10493hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10494@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10495@file{/dev/com1}:
10496
10497@smallexample
10498target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10499@end smallexample
10500
10501@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10502with it.
10503
10504To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10505
10506@smallexample
10507target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10508@end smallexample
10509
10510The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10511specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10512TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10513expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10514(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10515you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10516TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10517reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10518conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
d4f3574e 10519and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
10520@code{target remote} command.
10521
10522@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10523you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10524symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10525using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10526(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 10527running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
10528remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10529is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10530@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10531@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10532
10533@smallexample
10534(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10535@end smallexample
10536
10537@noindent
10538communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10539
10540@smallexample
10541(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10542@end smallexample
10543
10544@noindent
10545communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10546For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10547the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10548text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10549@samp{Connection refused}.
10550@end table
10551
6d2ebf8b 10552@node NetWare
104c1213
JM
10553@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10554
10555@kindex gdbserve.nlm
10556@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10557allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10558@code{target remote}.
10559
10560@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10561using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10562
10563@table @emph
10564@item On the target machine,
10565you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10566@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10567can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10568host system does all the symbol handling.
10569
10570To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10571@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10572program. The syntax is:
10573
5d161b24 10574@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10575load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10576 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10577@end smallexample
10578
10579@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10580the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
d4f3574e 10581to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
104c1213
JM
10582
10583For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
5d161b24 10584communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
d4f3574e 10585using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
104c1213
JM
10586
10587@smallexample
10588load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10589@end smallexample
10590
10591@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10592you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10593symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10594using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10595(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 10596running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
10597remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10598argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10599@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10600
10601@smallexample
10602(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10603@end smallexample
10604
10605@noindent
10606communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10607@end table
10608
6d2ebf8b 10609@node KOD
104c1213
JM
10610@section Kernel Object Display
10611
10612@cindex kernel object display
10613@cindex kernel object
10614@cindex KOD
10615
10616Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10617@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10618and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10619mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10620displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10621
10622Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10623@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10624
10625@example
2df3850c 10626(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
104c1213
JM
10627@end example
10628
10629If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10630about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10631which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10632after the operating system:
10633
10634@example
2df3850c 10635(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
104c1213
JM
10636List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10637Object Description
10638any Any and all objects
10639@end example
10640
10641Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10642by the kernel.
10643
10644There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
96baa820
JM
10645is supported other than to try it.
10646
10647
6d2ebf8b 10648@node Configurations
104c1213
JM
10649@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
10650
10651While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10652cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10653describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
10654
10655There are three major categories of configurations: native
10656configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10657operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10658different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10659are quite different from each other.
10660
10661@menu
10662* Native::
10663* Embedded OS::
10664* Embedded Processors::
10665* Architectures::
10666@end menu
10667
6d2ebf8b 10668@node Native
104c1213
JM
10669@section Native
10670
10671This section describes details specific to particular native
10672configurations.
10673
10674@menu
10675* HP-UX:: HP-UX
10676* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
10677@end menu
10678
6d2ebf8b 10679@node HP-UX
104c1213
JM
10680@subsection HP-UX
10681
10682On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10683begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10684name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10685
6d2ebf8b 10686@node SVR4 Process Information
104c1213
JM
10687@subsection SVR4 process information
10688
10689@kindex /proc
10690@cindex process image
10691
10692Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10693used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10694subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10695this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10696several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10697@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10698@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
10699and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
10700
10701@table @code
10702@kindex info proc
10703@item info proc
10704Summarize available information about the process.
10705
10706@kindex info proc mappings
10707@item info proc mappings
10708Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10709on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10710
10711@kindex info proc times
10712@item info proc times
10713Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10714its children.
10715
10716@kindex info proc id
10717@item info proc id
10718Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10719the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
10720
10721@kindex info proc status
10722@item info proc status
10723General information on the state of the process. If the process is
10724stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10725received.
10726
10727@item info proc all
10728Show all the above information about the process.
10729@end table
10730
6d2ebf8b 10731@node Embedded OS
104c1213
JM
10732@section Embedded Operating Systems
10733
10734This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
10735embedded operating systems that are available for several different
10736architectures.
10737
10738@menu
10739* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10740@end menu
10741
10742@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
10743various real-time operating systems.
10744
6d2ebf8b 10745@node VxWorks
104c1213
JM
10746@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10747
10748@cindex VxWorks
10749
10750@table @code
10751
10752@kindex target vxworks
10753@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
10754A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
10755is the target system's machine name or IP address.
10756
10757@end table
10758
10759On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
10760current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
10761
10762@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
10763VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
10764the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
10765both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
d4f3574e 10766@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
104c1213 10767installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
96a2c332 10768@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213
JM
10769
10770@table @code
10771@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
10772@kindex vxworks-timeout
5d161b24
DB
10773All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
10774This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
10775seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
10776your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
104c1213
JM
10777of a thin network line.
10778@end table
10779
10780The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
10781this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
10782procedures.
10783
10784@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
10785To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
10786to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
10787library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
10788VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
10789kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
10790source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
10791information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
10792manual.
10793@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
10794
10795Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
10796your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
96a2c332
SS
10797run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
10798@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213
JM
10799
10800@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
10801
10802@example
10803(vxgdb)
10804@end example
10805
10806@menu
10807* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
10808* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
10809* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
10810@end menu
10811
6d2ebf8b 10812@node VxWorks Connection
104c1213
JM
10813@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
10814
10815The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
10816network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
10817
10818@example
10819(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
10820@end example
10821
10822@need 750
10823@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
10824
10825@smallexample
5d161b24 10826Attaching remote machine across net...
104c1213
JM
10827Connected to tt.
10828@end smallexample
10829
10830@need 1000
10831@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
10832loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
10833these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
10834path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
10835to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
10836
10837@example
10838prog.o: No such file or directory.
10839@end example
10840
10841When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
10842the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
10843command again.
10844
6d2ebf8b 10845@node VxWorks Download
104c1213
JM
10846@subsubsection VxWorks download
10847
10848@cindex download to VxWorks
10849If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
10850object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
10851@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
10852incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
10853command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
10854to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
10855table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
10856the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
10857filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
10858Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
10859to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
10860the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
10861@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
10862and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
10863program, type this on VxWorks:
10864
10865@example
10866-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
10867@end example
d4f3574e
SS
10868
10869@noindent
104c1213
JM
10870Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
10871
10872@example
5d161b24 10873(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
104c1213
JM
10874(vxgdb) load prog.o
10875@end example
10876
10877@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
10878
10879@smallexample
10880Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
10881@end smallexample
10882
10883You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
10884after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
10885this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
10886auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
10887history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
d4f3574e 10888debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
104c1213
JM
10889table.)
10890
6d2ebf8b 10891@node VxWorks Attach
104c1213
JM
10892@subsubsection Running tasks
10893
10894@cindex running VxWorks tasks
10895You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
10896follows:
10897
10898@example
10899(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
10900@end example
10901
10902@noindent
10903where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
10904or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
10905the time of attachment.
10906
6d2ebf8b 10907@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
10908@section Embedded Processors
10909
10910This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
10911configurations.
10912
10913@menu
10914* A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
10915* ARM:: ARM
10916* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
10917* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
10918* i960:: Intel i960
10919* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
10920* M68K:: Motorola M68K
10921* M88K:: Motorola M88K
10922* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
10923* PA:: HP PA Embedded
10924* PowerPC: PowerPC
10925* SH:: Hitachi SH
10926* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
10927* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
10928* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
10929* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
10930@end menu
10931
6d2ebf8b 10932@node A29K Embedded
104c1213
JM
10933@subsection AMD A29K Embedded
10934
10935@menu
10936* A29K UDI::
10937* A29K EB29K::
10938* Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
10939* gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
10940* Remote Log:: Remote log
10941@end menu
10942
10943@table @code
10944
10945@kindex target adapt
10946@item target adapt @var{dev}
10947Adapt monitor for A29K.
10948
10949@kindex target amd-eb
10950@item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
10951@cindex AMD EB29K
10952Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
10953@var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
10954@var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
10955name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
10956@xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
10957
10958@end table
10959
6d2ebf8b 10960@node A29K UDI
104c1213
JM
10961@subsubsection A29K UDI
10962
10963@cindex UDI
10964@cindex AMD29K via UDI
10965
10966@value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
10967protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
10968configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
10969program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
10970use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
10971@code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
10972
10973@table @code
10974@item target udi @var{keyword}
10975@kindex udi
10976Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
10977@var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
10978This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
10979connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
10980working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
10981to its pathname.
10982@end table
10983
6d2ebf8b 10984@node A29K EB29K
104c1213
JM
10985@subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
10986
10987@cindex EB29K board
10988@cindex running 29K programs
10989
10990AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
10991with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
10992term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
10993@value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
10994must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
10995board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
10996assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
10997@file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
10998
6d2ebf8b 10999@node Comms (EB29K)
104c1213
JM
11000@subsubsection Communications setup
11001
11002The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
11003in DOS on the PC:
11004
11005@example
11006C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
11007@end example
11008
11009@noindent
11010This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
11011bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
11012you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
11013end of the connection as well.
11014@c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
5d161b24 11015@c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
11016@c
11017@c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
11018@c default value set when the DOS machines boots? "No retry" means that
11019@c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
11020@c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
11021@c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
104c1213
JM
11022
11023To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
11024the following at the DOS console:
11025
11026@example
11027C:\> CTTY com1
11028@end example
11029
11030@noindent
11031(Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
11032the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
96a2c332 11033had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line.)
104c1213
JM
11034
11035From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
11036@code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
11037
11038@example
11039cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
11040@end example
11041
11042@noindent
11043The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
11044serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
11045may look something like the following:
11046
11047@example
11048tip -9600 /dev/ttya
11049@end example
11050
11051@noindent
11052Your system may require a different name where we show
11053@file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
11054parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
11055@code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
11056system table @file{/etc/remote}.
11057@c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
11058@c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
11059@c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
11060@c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
11061@c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
11062@c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
11063@c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
11064@c
11065@c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
11066@c command. The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
11067@c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
104c1213
JM
11068
11069@kindex EBMON
11070Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
11071directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
11072start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
11073with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
11074@code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
11075@code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
11076
11077@example
11078C:\> G:
11079
11080G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
11081
11082G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
11083Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
11084Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
11085Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
11086
11087Enter '?' or 'H' for help
11088
11089PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
11090I/O Base = 0x208
11091Memory Base = 0xd0000
11092
11093Data Memory Size = 2048KB
11094Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
11095Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
11096
11097PageSize = 0x400
11098Register Stack Size = 0x800
11099Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
11100
11101CPU PRL = 0x3
11102Am29027 Available = No
11103Byte Write Available = Yes
11104
11105# ~.
11106@end example
11107
11108Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
11109typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
11110running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
11111
11112For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
11113way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
d4f3574e 11114system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
104c1213
JM
11115PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
11116something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
11117other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
11118from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
11119serial line.
11120
6d2ebf8b 11121@node gdb-EB29K
104c1213
JM
11122@subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
11123
11124Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
11125program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
11126name of your 29K program:
11127
11128@example
11129cd /usr/joe/work29k
11130@value{GDBP} myfoo
11131@end example
11132
11133@need 500
11134Now you can use the @code{target} command:
11135
11136@example
11137target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
11138@c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
11139@c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
11140@c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
11141@end example
11142
11143@noindent
11144In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
11145@file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
11146@code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
11147In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
11148a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
11149the name on the Unix side.
11150
11151At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
11152to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
11153@code{run}.
11154
11155To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
11156command.
11157
11158To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
11159once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
11160@code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
11161@code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
d4f3574e 11162Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
104c1213
JM
11163and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
11164
6d2ebf8b 11165@node Remote Log
104c1213 11166@subsubsection Remote log
41afff9a 11167@cindex @file{eb.log}, a log file for EB29K
104c1213
JM
11168@cindex log file for EB29K
11169
11170The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
11171current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
11172@file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
11173of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
11174another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
11175unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
11176
6d2ebf8b 11177@node ARM
104c1213
JM
11178@subsection ARM
11179
11180@table @code
11181
11182@kindex target rdi
11183@item target rdi @var{dev}
11184ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11185use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11186monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
5d161b24 11187
104c1213
JM
11188@kindex target rdp
11189@item target rdp @var{dev}
11190ARM Demon monitor.
11191
11192@end table
11193
6d2ebf8b 11194@node H8/300
104c1213
JM
11195@subsection Hitachi H8/300
11196
11197@table @code
11198
d4f3574e 11199@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
11200@item target hms @var{dev}
11201A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11202Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11203line and the communications speed used.
11204
d4f3574e 11205@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
11206@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11207E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11208
d4f3574e
SS
11209@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11210@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213 11211@item target sh3 @var{dev}
96a2c332 11212@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
104c1213
JM
11213Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11214
11215@end table
11216
11217@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11218@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11219@cindex download to Hitachi SH
11220@cindex Hitachi SH download
11221When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11222board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11223board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11224@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11225
11226@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
5d161b24 11227Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
104c1213
JM
11228
11229@enumerate
11230@item
11231that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11232for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11233emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
2df3850c 11234the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
104c1213
JM
11235H8/300, or H8/500.)
11236
11237@item
11238what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11239serial device available on your host is the default).
11240
11241@item
11242what speed to use over the serial device.
11243@end enumerate
11244
11245@menu
11246* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11247* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11248* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11249@end menu
11250
6d2ebf8b 11251@node Hitachi Boards
104c1213
JM
11252@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11253
11254@c only for Unix hosts
11255@kindex device
11256@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 11257Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
104c1213
JM
11258need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11259first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11260hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11261
11262@kindex speed
11263@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 11264@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
104c1213 11265speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
2df3850c 11266hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
d4f3574e
SS
11267the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11268@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
104c1213
JM
11269
11270The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11271use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11272use a DOS host,
11273@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11274called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11275through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11276to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11277
11278The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11279program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11280sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11281the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11282
11283First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11284board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11285port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11286When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
d4f3574e 11287debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
104c1213
JM
11288for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11289@code{COM2}.
11290
11291@example
11292C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11293C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11294
11295Resident portion of MODE loaded
11296
11297COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11298
11299@end example
11300
11301@quotation
11302@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11303@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11304disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11305your development board.
11306@end quotation
11307
d4f3574e 11308@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
104c1213
JM
11309Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11310connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
96a2c332 11311the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
104c1213
JM
11312you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11313commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11314cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11315download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11316the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11317(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11318executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11319@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11320itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11321
11322@smallexample
11323(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
2df3850c 11324@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 11325 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
104c1213 11326 the conditions.
5d161b24 11327There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
104c1213 11328for details.
2df3850c
JM
11329@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11330(@value{GDBP}) target hms
104c1213 11331Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
2df3850c 11332(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
104c1213
JM
11333.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11334.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11335.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11336@end smallexample
11337
11338At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11339you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11340sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11341@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11342resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11343@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11344
11345Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11346available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11347you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11348
11349Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11350@itemize @bullet
11351@item
11352to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11353no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11354
11355@item
11356to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11357normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11358to detect program completion.
11359@end itemize
11360
11361In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11362development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11363
6d2ebf8b 11364@node Hitachi ICE
104c1213
JM
11365@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11366
d4f3574e 11367@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
104c1213
JM
11368You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11369Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11370e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11371
11372@table @code
11373@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11374Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11375@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11376@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11377(for example, @samp{9600}).
11378
11379@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11380If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11381specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11382@end table
11383
6d2ebf8b 11384@node Hitachi Special
104c1213
JM
11385@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11386
11387Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11388
11389@table @code
11390
11391@kindex set machine
11392@kindex show machine
11393@item set machine h8300
11394@itemx set machine h8300h
11395Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11396architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11397to check which variant is currently in effect.
11398
11399@end table
11400
6d2ebf8b 11401@node H8/500
104c1213
JM
11402@subsection H8/500
11403
11404@table @code
11405
11406@kindex set memory @var{mod}
11407@cindex memory models, H8/500
11408@item set memory @var{mod}
11409@itemx show memory
11410Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11411@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11412memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11413@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
11414
11415@end table
11416
6d2ebf8b 11417@node i960
104c1213
JM
11418@subsection Intel i960
11419
11420@table @code
11421
11422@kindex target mon960
11423@item target mon960 @var{dev}
11424MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
11425
f0ca3dce 11426@kindex target nindy
104c1213
JM
11427@item target nindy @var{devicename}
11428An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
11429the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
11430@file{/dev/ttya}.
11431
11432@end table
11433
11434@cindex Nindy
11435@cindex i960
11436@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
11437@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
11438tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
11439
11440@itemize @bullet
11441@item
11442Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
11443Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
11444
11445@item
11446By responding to a prompt on startup;
11447
11448@item
11449By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
11450session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
11451
104c1213
JM
11452@end itemize
11453
11454@cindex download to Nindy-960
11455With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
11456downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
11457@value{GDBN}.
11458
11459@menu
11460* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
11461* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
11462* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
11463@end menu
11464
6d2ebf8b 11465@node Nindy Startup
104c1213
JM
11466@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
11467
11468If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
11469options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
11470reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
11471
11472@example
5d161b24 11473Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
104c1213
JM
11474@end example
11475
11476@noindent
11477Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
11478identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
11479simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
11480with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
11481use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11482
6d2ebf8b 11483@node Nindy Options
104c1213
JM
11484@subsubsection Options for Nindy
11485
11486These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
11487Nindy-960 board attached:
11488
11489@table @code
11490@item -r @var{port}
11491Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
11492to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
11493configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
11494@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
11495device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
11496suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
11497
11498@item -O
11499(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
11500the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
11501This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
11502target architecture.
11503
11504@quotation
11505@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
11506connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
11507fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
11508attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
11509this process with an interrupt.
11510@end quotation
11511
11512@item -brk
11513Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
11514system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
11515
11516@quotation
11517@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
11518requires; it only works with a few boards.
11519@end quotation
11520@end table
11521
11522The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
11523port.
11524
11525@c @group
6d2ebf8b 11526@node Nindy Reset
104c1213
JM
11527@subsubsection Nindy reset command
11528
11529@table @code
11530@item reset
11531@kindex reset
11532For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
11533system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
11534circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
11535a break is detected.
11536@end table
11537@c @end group
11538
6d2ebf8b 11539@node M32R/D
104c1213
JM
11540@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11541
11542@table @code
11543
11544@kindex target m32r
11545@item target m32r @var{dev}
11546Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11547
11548@end table
11549
6d2ebf8b 11550@node M68K
104c1213
JM
11551@subsection M68k
11552
11553The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11554target command for the following ROM monitors.
11555
11556@table @code
11557
11558@kindex target abug
11559@item target abug @var{dev}
11560ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11561
11562@kindex target cpu32bug
11563@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11564CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11565
11566@kindex target dbug
11567@item target dbug @var{dev}
11568dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11569
11570@kindex target est
11571@item target est @var{dev}
11572EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11573
11574@kindex target rom68k
11575@item target rom68k @var{dev}
11576ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11577
11578@end table
11579
11580If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
11581instead have only a single special target command:
11582
11583@table @code
11584
11585@kindex target es1800
11586@item target es1800 @var{dev}
11587ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
11588
11589@end table
11590
11591[context?]
11592
11593@table @code
11594
11595@kindex target rombug
11596@item target rombug @var{dev}
11597ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11598
11599@end table
11600
6d2ebf8b 11601@node M88K
104c1213
JM
11602@subsection M88K
11603
11604@table @code
11605
11606@kindex target bug
11607@item target bug @var{dev}
11608BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
11609
11610@end table
11611
6d2ebf8b 11612@node MIPS Embedded
104c1213
JM
11613@subsection MIPS Embedded
11614
11615@cindex MIPS boards
11616@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11617MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
11618you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
11619
11620@need 1000
11621Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
11622
11623@table @code
11624@item target mips @var{port}
11625@kindex target mips @var{port}
11626To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11627name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
11628command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11629the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
11630been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11631download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
11632
11633For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11634port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11635debugger:
11636
11637@example
11638host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
2df3850c
JM
11639@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11640(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11641(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11642(@value{GDBP}) run
104c1213
JM
11643@end example
11644
11645@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11646On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11647connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11648concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11649@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11650
11651@item target pmon @var{port}
11652@kindex target pmon @var{port}
11653PMON ROM monitor.
11654
11655@item target ddb @var{port}
11656@kindex target ddb @var{port}
11657NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
11658
11659@item target lsi @var{port}
11660@kindex target lsi @var{port}
11661LSI variant of PMON.
11662
11663@kindex target r3900
11664@item target r3900 @var{dev}
11665Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
11666
11667@kindex target array
11668@item target array @var{dev}
11669Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
11670
11671@end table
11672
11673
11674@noindent
11675@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
11676
11677@table @code
11678@item set processor @var{args}
11679@itemx show processor
11680@kindex set processor @var{args}
11681@kindex show processor
11682Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11683processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
5d161b24 11684For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
96c405b3 11685to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
5d161b24 11686Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
104c1213 11687is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
5d161b24 11688@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213
JM
11689
11690@item set mipsfpu double
11691@itemx set mipsfpu single
11692@itemx set mipsfpu none
11693@itemx show mipsfpu
11694@kindex set mipsfpu
11695@kindex show mipsfpu
11696@cindex MIPS remote floating point
11697@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11698If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11699coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
96a2c332 11700need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
104c1213
JM
11701file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11702functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11703@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11704functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11705with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11706processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11707double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11708@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
11709
11710In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11711floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11712and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
11713
11714As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11715@samp{show mipsfpu}.
11716
11717@item set remotedebug @var{n}
11718@itemx show remotedebug
d4f3574e
SS
11719@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11720@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
104c1213
JM
11721@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11722@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11723@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11724@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
11725You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11726by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
11727@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
11728to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
11729at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
11730
11731@item set timeout @var{seconds}
11732@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11733@itemx show timeout
11734@itemx show retransmit-timeout
11735@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11736@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11737@kindex set timeout
11738@kindex show timeout
11739@kindex set retransmit-timeout
11740@kindex show retransmit-timeout
11741You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11742remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
11743default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11744waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11745retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
11746You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11747retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11748@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
11749
11750The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
11751is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
11752forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
11753to run before stopping.
11754@end table
11755
6d2ebf8b 11756@node PowerPC
104c1213
JM
11757@subsection PowerPC
11758
11759@table @code
11760
11761@kindex target dink32
11762@item target dink32 @var{dev}
11763DINK32 ROM monitor.
11764
11765@kindex target ppcbug
11766@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
11767@kindex target ppcbug1
11768@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
11769PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
11770
11771@kindex target sds
11772@item target sds @var{dev}
11773SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
11774
11775@end table
11776
6d2ebf8b 11777@node PA
104c1213
JM
11778@subsection HP PA Embedded
11779
11780@table @code
11781
11782@kindex target op50n
11783@item target op50n @var{dev}
11784OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
11785
11786@kindex target w89k
11787@item target w89k @var{dev}
11788W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
11789
11790@end table
11791
6d2ebf8b 11792@node SH
104c1213
JM
11793@subsection Hitachi SH
11794
11795@table @code
11796
d4f3574e 11797@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
11798@item target hms @var{dev}
11799A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
11800commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
11801the communications speed used.
11802
d4f3574e 11803@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
11804@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11805E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
11806
d4f3574e
SS
11807@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
11808@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
104c1213
JM
11809@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11810@item target sh3e @var{dev}
11811Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11812
11813@end table
11814
6d2ebf8b 11815@node Sparclet
104c1213
JM
11816@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
11817
11818@cindex Sparclet
11819
5d161b24
DB
11820@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
11821Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
104c1213
JM
11822@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11823both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
5d161b24 11824@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213
JM
11825
11826@table @code
f0ca3dce 11827@item remotetimeout @var{args}
104c1213 11828@kindex remotetimeout
5d161b24
DB
11829@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
11830This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11831seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
11832@end table
11833
41afff9a 11834@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
5d161b24 11835When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
d4f3574e 11836information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
5d161b24 11837load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
d4f3574e 11838@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213
JM
11839
11840@example
11841sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
11842@end example
11843
d4f3574e 11844You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213
JM
11845
11846@example
11847sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
11848@end example
11849
41afff9a 11850@cindex running, on Sparclet
104c1213
JM
11851Once you have set
11852your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
5d161b24 11853run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
104c1213
JM
11854(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
11855
11856@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11857
11858@example
11859(gdbslet)
11860@end example
11861
11862@menu
11863* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
11864* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
11865* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
5d161b24 11866* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
11867@end menu
11868
6d2ebf8b 11869@node Sparclet File
104c1213
JM
11870@subsubsection Setting file to debug
11871
11872The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
11873
11874@example
11875(gdbslet) file prog
11876@end example
11877
11878@need 1000
11879@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
11880@value{GDBN} locates
11881the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
11882path.
11883If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
11884files will be searched as well.
11885@value{GDBN} locates
11886the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
11887path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
11888If it fails
11889to find a file, it displays a message such as:
11890
11891@example
11892prog: No such file or directory.
11893@end example
11894
11895When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
5d161b24 11896the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
104c1213
JM
11897@code{target} command again.
11898
6d2ebf8b 11899@node Sparclet Connection
104c1213
JM
11900@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
11901
11902The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
11903To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
11904
11905@example
11906(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
11907Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
5d161b24 11908main () at ../prog.c:3
104c1213
JM
11909@end example
11910
11911@need 750
11912@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11913
d4f3574e 11914@example
104c1213 11915Connected to ttya.
d4f3574e 11916@end example
104c1213 11917
6d2ebf8b 11918@node Sparclet Download
104c1213
JM
11919@subsubsection Sparclet download
11920
11921@cindex download to Sparclet
5d161b24 11922Once connected to the Sparclet target,
104c1213
JM
11923you can use the @value{GDBN}
11924@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
11925The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
11926command.
5d161b24 11927Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
d4f3574e 11928address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
104c1213
JM
11929offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
11930of each of the file's sections.
11931For instance, if the program
11932@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
11933and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
11934
11935@example
11936(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
11937Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
11938@end example
11939
5d161b24
DB
11940If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
11941to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
104c1213
JM
11942to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
11943
6d2ebf8b 11944@node Sparclet Execution
104c1213
JM
11945@subsubsection Running and debugging
11946
11947@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
11948You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
5d161b24 11949commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
11950manual for the list of commands.
11951
11952@example
11953(gdbslet) b main
11954Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
5d161b24 11955(gdbslet) run
104c1213
JM
11956Starting program: prog
11957Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
119583 char *symarg = 0;
11959(gdbslet) step
119604 char *execarg = "hello!";
5d161b24 11961(gdbslet)
104c1213
JM
11962@end example
11963
6d2ebf8b 11964@node Sparclite
104c1213
JM
11965@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
11966
11967@table @code
11968
11969@kindex target sparclite
11970@item target sparclite @var{dev}
5d161b24
DB
11971Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
11972You must use an additional command to debug the program.
11973For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
104c1213
JM
11974remote protocol.
11975
11976@end table
11977
6d2ebf8b 11978@node ST2000
104c1213
JM
11979@subsection Tandem ST2000
11980
2df3850c 11981@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
104c1213
JM
11982STDBUG protocol.
11983
11984To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
11985manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
11986
11987@example
11988target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
11989@end example
11990
11991@noindent
11992to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
11993the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
11994ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
11995connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
11996concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11997
11998The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
11999this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12000would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12001(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12002available on your host computer.
12003@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12004@c basically hearsay.
12005
12006@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12007These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12008environment:
12009
12010@table @code
12011@item st2000 @var{command}
12012@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12013@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12014@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12015Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12016manual for available commands.
12017
12018@item connect
12019@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12020Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12021you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12022sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12023@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12024@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
12025@end table
12026
6d2ebf8b 12027@node Z8000
104c1213
JM
12028@subsection Zilog Z8000
12029
12030@cindex Z8000
12031@cindex simulator, Z8000
12032@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
12033
12034When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12035a Z8000 simulator.
12036
12037For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12038unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12039segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12040appropriate by inspecting the object code.
12041
12042@table @code
12043@item target sim @var{args}
12044@kindex sim
d4f3574e 12045@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
104c1213
JM
12046Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12047options, specify them via @var{args}.
12048@end table
12049
12050@noindent
12051After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12052CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12053@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12054to run your program, and so on.
12055
d4f3574e
SS
12056As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12057(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12058additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
12059
12060@table @code
12061
12062@item cycles
12063Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
12064
12065@item insts
12066Counts instructions run in the simulator.
12067
12068@item time
12069Execution time in 60ths of a second.
12070
12071@end table
12072
12073You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12074conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12075conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12076simulated clock ticks.
12077
6d2ebf8b 12078@node Architectures
104c1213
JM
12079@section Architectures
12080
12081This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
2df3850c 12082all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213
JM
12083
12084@menu
12085* A29K::
12086* Alpha::
12087* MIPS::
12088@end menu
12089
6d2ebf8b 12090@node A29K
104c1213
JM
12091@subsection A29K
12092
12093@table @code
12094
12095@kindex set rstack_high_address
12096@cindex AMD 29K register stack
12097@cindex register stack, AMD29K
12098@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12099On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
d4f3574e 12100@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
104c1213
JM
12101extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12102stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12103memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12104this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12105the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12106address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12107hexadecimal.
12108
12109@kindex show rstack_high_address
12110@item show rstack_high_address
12111Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12112processors.
12113
12114@end table
12115
6d2ebf8b 12116@node Alpha
104c1213
JM
12117@subsection Alpha
12118
12119See the following section.
12120
6d2ebf8b 12121@node MIPS
104c1213
JM
12122@subsection MIPS
12123
12124@cindex stack on Alpha
12125@cindex stack on MIPS
12126@cindex Alpha stack
12127@cindex MIPS stack
12128Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12129sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12130find the beginning of a function.
12131
12132@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12133To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12134@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12135you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12136commands:
12137
12138@table @code
00e4a2e4 12139@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
104c1213
JM
12140@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12141Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12142search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12143default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12144larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12145and therefore the longer it takes to run.
12146
12147@item show heuristic-fence-post
12148Display the current limit.
12149@end table
12150
12151@noindent
12152These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12153for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
12154
12155
6d2ebf8b 12156@node Controlling GDB
c906108c
SS
12157@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12158
53a5351d
JM
12159You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12160@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
d4f3574e 12161data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
53a5351d 12162described here.
c906108c
SS
12163
12164@menu
12165* Prompt:: Prompt
12166* Editing:: Command editing
12167* History:: Command history
12168* Screen Size:: Screen size
12169* Numbers:: Numbers
12170* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
5d161b24 12171* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
c906108c
SS
12172@end menu
12173
6d2ebf8b 12174@node Prompt
c906108c
SS
12175@section Prompt
12176
12177@cindex prompt
12178
12179@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12180called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12181can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12182instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
5d161b24 12183the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
c906108c
SS
12184which one you are talking to.
12185
d4f3574e 12186@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
c906108c
SS
12187prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12188or a prompt that does not.
12189
12190@table @code
12191@kindex set prompt
12192@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12193Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
12194
12195@kindex show prompt
12196@item show prompt
12197Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
12198@end table
12199
6d2ebf8b 12200@node Editing
c906108c
SS
12201@section Command editing
12202@cindex readline
12203@cindex command line editing
12204
12205@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12206@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12207command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12208or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12209substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12210debugging sessions.
12211
12212You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12213command @code{set}.
12214
12215@table @code
12216@kindex set editing
12217@cindex editing
12218@item set editing
12219@itemx set editing on
12220Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
12221
12222@item set editing off
12223Disable command line editing.
12224
12225@kindex show editing
12226@item show editing
12227Show whether command line editing is enabled.
12228@end table
12229
6d2ebf8b 12230@node History
c906108c
SS
12231@section Command history
12232
12233@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12234debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12235happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12236history facility.
12237
12238@table @code
12239@cindex history substitution
12240@cindex history file
12241@kindex set history filename
12242@kindex GDBHISTFILE
12243@item set history filename @var{fname}
12244Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12245This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12246list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12247exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12248the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12249to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
d4f3574e
SS
12250@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12251is not set.
c906108c
SS
12252
12253@cindex history save
12254@kindex set history save
12255@item set history save
12256@itemx set history save on
12257Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12258@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
12259
12260@item set history save off
12261Stop recording command history in a file.
12262
12263@cindex history size
12264@kindex set history size
12265@item set history size @var{size}
12266Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12267This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12268@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
12269@end table
12270
12271@cindex history expansion
12272History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12273@ifset have-readline-appendices
12274@xref{Event Designators}.
12275@end ifset
12276
12277Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12278is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12279@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12280follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12281a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12282history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12283@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12284
12285The commands to control history expansion are:
12286
12287@table @code
12288@kindex set history expansion
12289@item set history expansion on
12290@itemx set history expansion
12291Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
12292
12293@item set history expansion off
12294Disable history expansion.
12295
12296The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12297editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12298or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12299@ifset have-readline-appendices
12300@xref{Command Line Editing}.
12301@end ifset
12302
12303@c @group
12304@kindex show history
12305@item show history
12306@itemx show history filename
12307@itemx show history save
12308@itemx show history size
12309@itemx show history expansion
12310These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12311@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12312@c @end group
12313@end table
12314
12315@table @code
41afff9a 12316@kindex shows
c906108c
SS
12317@item show commands
12318Display the last ten commands in the command history.
12319
12320@item show commands @var{n}
12321Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12322
12323@item show commands +
12324Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
12325@end table
12326
6d2ebf8b 12327@node Screen Size
c906108c
SS
12328@section Screen size
12329@cindex size of screen
12330@cindex pauses in output
12331
12332Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12333information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12334@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12335output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12336to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12337determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12338printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12339rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12340
d4f3574e
SS
12341Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12342driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
c906108c 12343together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
d4f3574e 12344@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
c906108c
SS
12345you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12346width} commands:
12347
12348@table @code
12349@kindex set height
12350@kindex set width
12351@kindex show width
12352@kindex show height
12353@item set height @var{lpp}
12354@itemx show height
12355@itemx set width @var{cpl}
12356@itemx show width
12357These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12358a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12359commands display the current settings.
12360
5d161b24
DB
12361If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12362output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
c906108c
SS
12363file or to an editor buffer.
12364
12365Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12366from wrapping its output.
12367@end table
12368
6d2ebf8b 12369@node Numbers
c906108c
SS
12370@section Numbers
12371@cindex number representation
12372@cindex entering numbers
12373
2df3850c
JM
12374You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12375@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12376@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12377begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12378default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12379numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12380change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12381radix} command.
c906108c
SS
12382
12383@table @code
12384@kindex set input-radix
12385@item set input-radix @var{base}
12386Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12387for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12388specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12389example, any of
12390
12391@smallexample
12392set radix 012
12393set radix 10.
12394set radix 0xa
12395@end smallexample
12396
12397@noindent
12398sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12399leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
12400
12401@kindex set output-radix
12402@item set output-radix @var{base}
12403Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12404for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12405specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
12406
12407@kindex show input-radix
12408@item show input-radix
12409Display the current default base for numeric input.
12410
12411@kindex show output-radix
12412@item show output-radix
12413Display the current default base for numeric display.
12414@end table
12415
6d2ebf8b 12416@node Messages/Warnings
c906108c
SS
12417@section Optional warnings and messages
12418
2df3850c
JM
12419By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12420running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12421command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12422internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
c906108c
SS
12423
12424Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12425which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12426see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
12427
12428@table @code
12429@kindex set verbose
12430@item set verbose on
12431Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12432
12433@item set verbose off
12434Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12435
12436@kindex show verbose
12437@item show verbose
12438Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12439@end table
12440
2df3850c
JM
12441By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12442object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12443find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12444symbol files}).
c906108c
SS
12445
12446@table @code
2df3850c 12447
c906108c
SS
12448@kindex set complaints
12449@item set complaints @var{limit}
2df3850c
JM
12450Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12451unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12452@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12453to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
c906108c
SS
12454
12455@kindex show complaints
12456@item show complaints
12457Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
2df3850c 12458
c906108c
SS
12459@end table
12460
12461By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12462lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12463you try to run a program which is already running:
12464
12465@example
12466(@value{GDBP}) run
12467The program being debugged has been started already.
12468Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
12469@end example
12470
12471If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12472commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
12473
12474@table @code
2df3850c 12475
c906108c
SS
12476@kindex set confirm
12477@cindex flinching
12478@cindex confirmation
12479@cindex stupid questions
12480@item set confirm off
12481Disables confirmation requests.
12482
12483@item set confirm on
12484Enables confirmation requests (the default).
12485
12486@kindex show confirm
12487@item show confirm
12488Displays state of confirmation requests.
2df3850c 12489
c906108c
SS
12490@end table
12491
6d2ebf8b 12492@node Debugging Output
5d161b24
DB
12493@section Optional messages about internal happenings
12494@table @code
12495@kindex set debug arch
12496@item set debug arch
12497Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12498@kindex show debug arch
12499@item show debug arch
12500Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12501@kindex set debug event
12502@item set debug event
12503Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12504default is off.
12505@kindex show debug event
12506@item show debug event
12507Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12508info.
12509@kindex set debug expression
12510@item set debug expression
12511Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12512default is off.
12513@kindex show debug expression
12514@item show debug expression
12515Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12516debugging info.
12517@kindex set debug overload
12518@item set debug overload
b37052ae 12519Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
5d161b24
DB
12520info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
12521is off.
12522@kindex show debug overload
12523@item show debug overload
b37052ae 12524Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
5d161b24
DB
12525debugging info.
12526@kindex set debug remote
12527@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
12528@cindex serial connections, debugging
12529@item set debug remote
12530Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
12531the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
12532@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
12533@kindex show debug remote
12534@item show debug remote
12535Displays the state of display of remote packets.
12536@kindex set debug serial
12537@item set debug serial
12538Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
12539default is off.
12540@kindex show debug serial
12541@item show debug serial
12542Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
12543info.
12544@kindex set debug target
12545@item set debug target
12546Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
12547includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
12548default is off.
12549@kindex show debug target
12550@item show debug target
12551Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
12552info.
12553@kindex set debug varobj
12554@item set debug varobj
12555Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
12556info. The default is off.
12557@kindex show debug varobj
12558@item show debug varobj
12559Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
12560debugging info.
12561@end table
12562
6d2ebf8b 12563@node Sequences
c906108c
SS
12564@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
12565
12566Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
2df3850c
JM
12567command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
12568commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
12569files.
c906108c
SS
12570
12571@menu
12572* Define:: User-defined commands
12573* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
12574* Command Files:: Command files
12575* Output:: Commands for controlled output
12576@end menu
12577
6d2ebf8b 12578@node Define
c906108c
SS
12579@section User-defined commands
12580
12581@cindex user-defined command
2df3850c
JM
12582A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
12583which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
12584@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
12585separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
12586via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
c906108c
SS
12587
12588@smallexample
12589define adder
12590 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
12591@end smallexample
12592
d4f3574e
SS
12593@noindent
12594To execute the command use:
c906108c
SS
12595
12596@smallexample
12597adder 1 2 3
12598@end smallexample
12599
d4f3574e
SS
12600@noindent
12601This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
5d161b24 12602its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
c906108c
SS
12603reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
12604functions calls.
12605
12606@table @code
2df3850c 12607
c906108c
SS
12608@kindex define
12609@item define @var{commandname}
12610Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
12611by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
12612
12613The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
12614which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
12615commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
12616
12617@kindex if
12618@kindex else
12619@item if
12620Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
12621It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
12622only if the expression is true (nonzero).
12623There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
12624by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
12625was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
12626
12627@kindex while
12628@item while
12629The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
12630which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
12631execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
12632The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
12633evaluates to true.
12634
12635@kindex document
12636@item document @var{commandname}
12637Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
5d161b24
DB
12638accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
12639defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
12640reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
12641After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
c906108c
SS
12642@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
12643
12644You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
12645documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
12646does not change the documentation.
12647
12648@kindex help user-defined
12649@item help user-defined
12650List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
12651(if any) for each.
12652
12653@kindex show user
12654@item show user
12655@itemx show user @var{commandname}
2df3850c
JM
12656Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
12657not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
c906108c 12658definitions for all user-defined commands.
2df3850c 12659
c906108c
SS
12660@end table
12661
12662When user-defined commands are executed, the
12663commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
12664stops execution of the user-defined command.
12665
12666If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
5d161b24
DB
12667without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
12668commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
c906108c
SS
12669messages when used in a user-defined command.
12670
6d2ebf8b 12671@node Hooks
c906108c 12672@section User-defined command hooks
d4f3574e
SS
12673@cindex command hooks
12674@cindex hooks, for commands
c78b4128 12675@cindex hooks, pre-command
c906108c 12676
c78b4128
EZ
12677@kindex hook
12678@kindex hook-
12679You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
c906108c
SS
12680command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12681command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12682before that command.
12683
c78b4128
EZ
12684@cindex hooks, post-command
12685@kindex hookpost
12686@kindex hookpost-
12687A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12688Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12689@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12690that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12691pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
12692
12693It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
12694occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
12695
12696@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
12697@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
12698
d4f3574e 12699@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
c906108c
SS
12700In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
12701(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
12702execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
12703displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
12704
c906108c
SS
12705For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
12706single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
12707you could define:
12708
12709@example
12710define hook-stop
12711handle SIGALRM nopass
12712end
12713
12714define hook-run
12715handle SIGALRM pass
12716end
12717
12718define hook-continue
12719handle SIGLARM pass
12720end
12721@end example
c906108c 12722
c78b4128
EZ
12723As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
12724command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
12725you could define:
12726
12727@example
12728define hook-echo
12729echo <<<---
12730end
12731
12732define hookpost-echo
12733echo --->>>\n
12734end
12735
12736(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
12737<<<---Hello World--->>>
12738(@value{GDBP})
12739
12740@end example
12741
c906108c
SS
12742You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
12743not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
12744name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
12745@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
12746@c or not?
12747If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
12748@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
12749(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
12750
12751If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
12752get a warning from the @code{define} command.
12753
6d2ebf8b 12754@node Command Files
c906108c
SS
12755@section Command files
12756
12757@cindex command files
5d161b24
DB
12758A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
12759commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
12760An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
c906108c
SS
12761the last command, as it would from the terminal.
12762
12763@cindex init file
12764@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
d4f3574e 12765@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
c906108c 12766When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
bf0184be
ND
12767@dfn{init files}. These are files named @file{.gdbinit} on Unix and
12768@file{gdb.ini} on DOS/Windows. During startup, @value{GDBN} does the
12769following:
12770
12771@enumerate
12772@item
12773Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
12774DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
12775@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
12776
12777@item
12778Processes command line options and operands.
12779
12780@item
12781Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
12782
12783@item
12784Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
12785@end enumerate
12786
12787The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
12788complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
12789and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
12790option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 12791
c906108c
SS
12792@cindex init file name
12793On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
12794different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
12795form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
12796different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
12797environments with special init file names:
12798
00e4a2e4 12799@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c
SS
12800@itemize @bullet
12801@item
00e4a2e4 12802VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 12803
00e4a2e4 12804@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 12805@item
00e4a2e4 12806OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 12807
00e4a2e4 12808@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
c906108c 12809@item
00e4a2e4 12810ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
c906108c 12811@end itemize
c906108c
SS
12812
12813You can also request the execution of a command file with the
12814@code{source} command:
12815
12816@table @code
12817@kindex source
12818@item source @var{filename}
12819Execute the command file @var{filename}.
12820@end table
12821
12822The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
12823printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
12824of the command file.
12825
12826Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
12827without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
12828normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
12829when called from command files.
12830
6d2ebf8b 12831@node Output
c906108c
SS
12832@section Commands for controlled output
12833
12834During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
12835@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
12836explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
12837describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
12838want.
12839
12840@table @code
12841@kindex echo
12842@item echo @var{text}
12843@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
12844@c because it is not in ANSI.
12845Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
12846@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
12847newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
12848In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
12849by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
12850string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
5d161b24 12851trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
c906108c
SS
12852To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
12853@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
12854
12855A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
12856the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
12857
12858@example
12859echo This is some text\n\
12860which is continued\n\
12861onto several lines.\n
12862@end example
12863
12864produces the same output as
12865
12866@example
12867echo This is some text\n
12868echo which is continued\n
12869echo onto several lines.\n
12870@end example
12871
12872@kindex output
12873@item output @var{expression}
12874Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
12875newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
5d161b24 12876value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
c906108c
SS
12877on expressions.
12878
12879@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
12880Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
12881the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
12882formats}, for more information.
12883
12884@kindex printf
12885@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
12886Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
12887@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
12888either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
12889@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
12890subroutine
d4f3574e
SS
12891@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
12892@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
12893@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
12894@c supported.
c906108c
SS
12895
12896@example
12897printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
12898@end example
12899
12900For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
12901
12902@smallexample
12903printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
12904@end smallexample
12905
12906The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
12907string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
12908letter.
12909@end table
12910
6d2ebf8b 12911@node Emacs
c906108c
SS
12912@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
12913
12914@cindex Emacs
12915@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
12916A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
12917edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
12918@value{GDBN}.
12919
12920To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
12921executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
12922@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
12923created Emacs buffer.
53a5351d 12924@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c
SS
12925
12926Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
12927things:
12928
12929@itemize @bullet
12930@item
12931All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
12932@end itemize
12933
12934This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
12935and output done by the program you are debugging.
12936
12937This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
12938commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
12939in this way.
12940
12941All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
12942with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
12943way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
12944stop.
12945
12946@itemize @bullet
12947@item
12948@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
12949@end itemize
12950
12951Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
12952source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
12953left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
12954source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
12955and the source.
12956
12957Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
12958usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
12959
12960@quotation
12961@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
12962current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
12963the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
12964appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
12965environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
12966session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
12967back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
12968avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
12969your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
12970@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
12971
12972A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
12973switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
12974@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
12975@end quotation
12976
12977By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
12978you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
12979several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
12980Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
12981
12982@example
12983(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
12984@end example
12985
12986@noindent
d4f3574e 12987(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
c906108c
SS
12988in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
12989``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
12990
12991In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
12992addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
12993
12994@table @kbd
12995@item C-h m
12996Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
12997
12998@item M-s
12999Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13000update the display window to show the current file and location.
13001
13002@item M-n
13003Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13004calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13005to show the current file and location.
13006
13007@item M-i
13008Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13009display window accordingly.
13010
13011@item M-x gdb-nexti
13012Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13013display window accordingly.
13014
13015@item C-c C-f
13016Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13017@code{finish} command.
13018
13019@item M-c
13020Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13021command.
13022
13023@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
13024
13025@item M-u
13026Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13027(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13028like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
13029
13030@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
13031
13032@item M-d
13033Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13034@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
13035
13036@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
13037
13038@item C-x &
13039Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
13040of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
13041around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
13042then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
13043argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
13044
13045You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
13046@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
13047otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
13048inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
13049wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
13050list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
13051formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
13052is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
13053@end table
13054
13055In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
13056tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
13057
13058If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
13059it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
13060request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
13061the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
13062frame.
13063
13064The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
13065which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
13066the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
13067communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
13068delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
13069to correspond properly with the code.
13070
13071@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
13072@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
13073@ignore
13074@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
13075@kindex Epoch
13076@kindex inspect
13077
5d161b24 13078Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
c906108c
SS
13079called the @code{epoch}
13080environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
13081@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
13082each value is printed in its own window.
13083@end ignore
c906108c 13084
d700128c 13085@include annotate.texi
7162c0ca 13086@include gdbmi.texinfo
d700128c 13087
6d2ebf8b 13088@node GDB Bugs
c906108c
SS
13089@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
13090@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
13091@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
13092
13093Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
13094
13095Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
13096may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
13097the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
13098reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
13099
13100In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
13101information that enables us to fix the bug.
13102
13103@menu
13104* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
13105* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
13106@end menu
13107
6d2ebf8b 13108@node Bug Criteria
c906108c
SS
13109@section Have you found a bug?
13110@cindex bug criteria
13111
13112If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
13113
13114@itemize @bullet
13115@cindex fatal signal
13116@cindex debugger crash
13117@cindex crash of debugger
13118@item
13119If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
13120@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
13121
13122@cindex error on valid input
13123@item
13124If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
13125bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
13126somewhere in the connection to the target.)
13127
13128@cindex invalid input
13129@item
13130If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
13131that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
13132``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
13133for traditional practice''.
13134
13135@item
13136If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
13137for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
13138@end itemize
13139
6d2ebf8b 13140@node Bug Reporting
c906108c
SS
13141@section How to report bugs
13142@cindex bug reports
13143@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
13144
c906108c
SS
13145A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
13146If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
13147contact that organization first.
13148
13149You can find contact information for many support companies and
13150individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
13151distribution.
13152@c should add a web page ref...
13153
13154In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
13155@value{GDBN} to this addresses:
13156
13157@example
d4f3574e 13158bug-gdb@@gnu.org
c906108c
SS
13159@end example
13160
13161@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
d4f3574e 13162@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
c906108c
SS
13163not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
13164@samp{bug-gdb}.
13165
13166The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
13167serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
13168the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
13169newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
13170problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
13171path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
13172we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
13173bug reports to the mailing list.
13174
13175As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
13176
13177@example
13178@sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
13179Free Software Foundation Inc.
1318059 Temple Place - Suite 330
13181Boston, MA 02111-1307
13182USA
13183@end example
c906108c
SS
13184
13185The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
13186@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
13187fact or leave it out, state it!
13188
13189Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
13190problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
13191assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
13192Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
13193stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
13194name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
13195of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
13196the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
13197easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
13198
13199Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
13200bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
13201you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
13202self-contained.
13203
13204Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
13205bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
13206@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
13207bugs properly.
13208
13209To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
13210
13211@itemize @bullet
13212@item
13213The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
13214with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
13215version}.
13216
13217Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
13218the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
13219
13220@item
13221The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
13222version number.
13223
c906108c
SS
13224@item
13225What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
13226``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c906108c
SS
13227
13228@item
13229What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
13230debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
13231C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
13232information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
13233compilers.
13234
13235@item
13236The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
13237observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
13238you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
13239Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
13240
13241If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
13242and then we might not encounter the bug.
13243
13244@item
13245A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
13246reproduce the bug.
13247
13248@item
13249A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
13250incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
13251
13252Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
13253will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
13254not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
13255a chance to make a mistake.
13256
13257Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
13258say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
13259copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
13260the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
13261crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
13262ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
13263us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
13264to draw any conclusion from our observations.
13265
c906108c
SS
13266@item
13267If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
13268diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
13269it by context, not by line number.
13270
13271The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
13272sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
53a5351d 13273
c906108c
SS
13274@end itemize
13275
13276Here are some things that are not necessary:
13277
13278@itemize @bullet
13279@item
13280A description of the envelope of the bug.
13281
13282Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
13283which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
13284changes will not affect it.
13285
13286This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
13287will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
13288with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
13289We recommend that you save your time for something else.
13290
13291Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
13292of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
13293output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
13294less time, and so on.
13295
13296However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
13297report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
13298
13299@item
13300A patch for the bug.
13301
13302A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
13303the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
13304a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
13305to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
13306
13307Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
13308construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
13309through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
13310to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
13311
13312And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
13313patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
13314help us to understand.
13315
13316@item
13317A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
13318
13319Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
13320things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
13321@end itemize
13322
5d161b24 13323@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
c906108c
SS
13324@c and consists of the two following files:
13325@c rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 13326@c inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
13327@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
13328@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
13329@include rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 13330@include inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
13331
13332
6d2ebf8b 13333@node Formatting Documentation
c906108c
SS
13334@appendix Formatting Documentation
13335
13336@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
13337@cindex reference card
13338The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
13339for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
13340subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
13341@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
13342release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
13343you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
13344
13345The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
13346can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
13347
13348@example
13349make refcard.dvi
13350@end example
13351
5d161b24
DB
13352The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
13353mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
c906108c
SS
13354that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
13355high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
13356your @sc{dvi} output program.
13357
13358@cindex documentation
13359
13360All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
13361distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
13362a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
13363on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
13364formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
13365and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
13366
13367@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
13368version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
13369file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
13370subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
13371necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
13372but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
13373Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
13374@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
13375
13376If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
13377Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
13378@code{makeinfo}.
13379
13380If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
13381@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
13382version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
13383
13384@example
13385cd gdb
13386make gdb.info
13387@end example
13388
13389If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
13390a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
13391Texinfo definitions file.
13392
13393@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
13394produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
13395document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
13396has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
13397command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
13398(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
13399require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
13400
13401@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
13402@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
13403written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
13404typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
13405and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
13406directory.
13407
13408If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
13409typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
13410subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
13411@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
13412
13413@example
13414make gdb.dvi
13415@end example
13416
13417Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c906108c 13418
6d2ebf8b 13419@node Installing GDB
c906108c
SS
13420@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
13421@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
13422@cindex installation
13423
c906108c
SS
13424@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
13425of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
13426build the @code{gdb} program.
13427@iftex
13428@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
13429@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
13430look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
13431installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
13432@end iftex
13433
5d161b24
DB
13434The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
13435@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
c906108c
SS
13436appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
13437
13438For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
13439@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
13440
13441@table @code
13442@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
13443script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
13444
13445@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
13446the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
13447
13448@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13449source for the Binary File Descriptor library
13450
13451@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
13452@sc{gnu} include files
13453
13454@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
13455source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
13456
13457@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
13458source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
13459
13460@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
13461source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
13462
13463@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
13464source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
13465
13466@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
13467source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
13468@end table
13469
13470The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
13471from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
13472this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
13473
13474First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
13475if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
13476identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
13477argument.
13478
13479For example:
13480
13481@example
13482cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
13483./configure @var{host}
13484make
13485@end example
13486
13487@noindent
13488where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
13489@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
13490(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
13491correct value by examining your system.)
13492
13493Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
13494@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
13495libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
13496binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
13497
13498@need 750
13499@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
13500system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
13501shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
13502
13503@example
13504sh configure @var{host}
13505@end example
13506
13507If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
13508directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
13509@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
13510creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
13511you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
13512
13513You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
13514subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
13515configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
13516
13517For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
13518the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
13519
13520@example
13521@group
13522cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13523../configure @var{host}
13524@end group
13525@end example
13526
13527You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
13528However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
13529the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
13530that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
13531let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
13532
13533@menu
13534* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
13535* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
13536* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
13537@end menu
13538
6d2ebf8b 13539@node Separate Objdir
c906108c
SS
13540@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
13541
13542If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
13543you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
13544host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
13545allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
13546rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
13547handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
13548@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
13549program specified there.
13550
13551To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
13552with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
13553(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
13554itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
13555would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
13556the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
13557
5d161b24 13558For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
c906108c
SS
13559separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
13560
13561@example
13562@group
13563cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
13564mkdir ../gdb-sun4
13565cd ../gdb-sun4
13566../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
13567make
13568@end group
13569@end example
13570
13571When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
13572directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
13573(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
13574the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
13575directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
13576@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
13577
13578One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
5d161b24
DB
13579directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
13580@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
13581programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
c906108c
SS
13582You specify a cross-debugging target by
13583giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
13584
13585When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
13586it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
13587called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
13588
13589The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
13590directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
13591directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
13592directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
13593will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
13594
13595When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
13596directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
13597if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
13598with each other.
13599
6d2ebf8b 13600@node Config Names
c906108c
SS
13601@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
13602
13603The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
13604script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
13605aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
13606of information in the following pattern:
13607
13608@example
13609@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
13610@end example
13611
13612For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
13613or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
13614option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
13615
13616The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
13617any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
13618aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
13619@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
13620script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
13621abbreviations---for example:
13622
13623@smallexample
13624% sh config.sub i386-linux
13625i386-pc-linux-gnu
13626% sh config.sub alpha-linux
13627alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
13628% sh config.sub hp9k700
13629hppa1.1-hp-hpux
13630% sh config.sub sun4
13631sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
13632% sh config.sub sun3
13633m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
13634% sh config.sub i986v
13635Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
13636@end smallexample
13637
13638@noindent
13639@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
13640directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
13641
6d2ebf8b 13642@node Configure Options
c906108c
SS
13643@section @code{configure} options
13644
13645Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
13646are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
13647several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
13648Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
13649
13650@example
13651configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
13652 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
13653 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
13654 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
13655 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
13656 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
13657 @var{host}
13658@end example
13659
13660@noindent
13661You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
13662@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
13663@samp{--}.
13664
13665@table @code
13666@item --help
13667Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
13668
13669@item --prefix=@var{dir}
13670Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
13671@file{@var{dir}}.
13672
13673@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
13674Configure the source to install programs under directory
13675@file{@var{dir}}.
13676
13677@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
13678@need 2000
13679@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
13680@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
13681@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
13682Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
13683@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
13684build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
13685directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
13686the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
13687directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
13688the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
13689@var{dirname}.
13690
13691@item --norecursion
13692Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
13693propagate configuration to subdirectories.
13694
13695@item --target=@var{target}
13696Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
13697@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
13698programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
13699
13700There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
13701
13702@item @var{host} @dots{}
13703Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
13704
13705There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
13706@end table
13707
13708There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
13709needed for special purposes only.
5d161b24 13710
6d2ebf8b 13711@node Index
c906108c
SS
13712@unnumbered Index
13713
13714@printindex cp
13715
13716@tex
13717% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
13718% meantime:
13719\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
13720\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
13721\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
13722\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
13723\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
13724\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
13725\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
13726\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
13727\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
13728\page\colophon
13729% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
13730@end tex
13731
449f3b6c
AC
13732@c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
13733@ifinfo
c906108c 13734@contents
449f3b6c
AC
13735@end ifinfo
13736@ifhtml
13737@contents
13738@end ifhtml
13739
c906108c 13740@bye
This page took 0.694211 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.